]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/org.texi
6a39dcf122105f1d498490c387828b0eab0cf64a
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / org.texi
1
2 \input texinfo
3 @c %**start of header
4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
6
7 @set VERSION 7.4
8 @set DATE December 2010
9
10 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
11 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
12 @set txicodequoteundirected
13 @set txicodequotebacktick
14
15 @c Version and Contact Info
16 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
17 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
19 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
20 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
21 @c %**end of header
22 @finalout
23
24
25 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
26
27 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
28 @c =======================================
29
30 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
31 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
32
33 @set cmdnames
34
35 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
36
37 @c orgkey{key} A key item
38 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
39 @c xorgcmd{key,cmmand} Key with command name as @itemx
40 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
41 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
42 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
43 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
44 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
45 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
46 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
47 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
48
49 @c a key but no command
50 @c Inserts: @item key
51 @macro orgkey{key}
52 @kindex \key\
53 @item @kbd{\key\}
54 @end macro
55
56 @macro xorgkey{key}
57 @kindex \key\
58 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
59 @end macro
60
61 @c one key with a command
62 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
63 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
64 @ifset cmdnames
65 @kindex \key\
66 @findex \command\
67 @iftex
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
69 @end iftex
70 @ifnottex
71 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
72 @end ifnottex
73 @end ifset
74 @ifclear cmdnames
75 @kindex \key\
76 @item @kbd{\key\}
77 @end ifclear
78 @end macro
79
80 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
81 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
82 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
83 @ifset cmdnames
84 @kindex \key\
85 @findex \command\
86 @iftex
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
88 @end iftex
89 @ifnottex
90 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
91 @end ifnottex
92 @end ifset
93 @ifclear cmdnames
94 @kindex \key\
95 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
96 @end ifclear
97 @end macro
98
99 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
100 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
101 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
102 @ifset cmdnames
103 @findex \command\
104 @iftex
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
106 @end iftex
107 @ifnottex
108 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
109 @end ifnottex
110 @end ifset
111 @ifclear cmdnames
112 @item @kbd{\key\}
113 @end ifclear
114 @end macro
115
116 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
117 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
118 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
119 @ifset cmdnames
120 @kindex \key\
121 @findex \command\
122 @iftex
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
124 @end iftex
125 @ifnottex
126 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
127 @end ifnottex
128 @end ifset
129 @ifclear cmdnames
130 @kindex \key\
131 @item @kbd{\text\}
132 @end ifclear
133 @end macro
134
135 @c two keys with one command
136 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
137 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
138 @ifset cmdnames
139 @kindex \key1\
140 @kindex \key2\
141 @findex \command\
142 @iftex
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
144 @end iftex
145 @ifnottex
146 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
147 @end ifnottex
148 @end ifset
149 @ifclear cmdnames
150 @kindex \key1\
151 @kindex \key2\
152 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
153 @end ifclear
154 @end macro
155
156 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
157 @c @itemx
158 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
159 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
160 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
161 @ifset cmdnames
162 @kindex \key1\
163 @kindex \key2\
164 @findex \command\
165 @iftex
166 @item @kbd{\key1\}
167 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
168 @end iftex
169 @ifnottex
170 @item @kbd{\key1\}
171 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
172 @end ifnottex
173 @end ifset
174 @ifclear cmdnames
175 @kindex \key1\
176 @kindex \key2\
177 @item @kbd{\key1\}
178 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
179 @end ifclear
180 @end macro
181
182 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
183 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
184 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
185 @ifset cmdnames
186 @kindex \key1\
187 @kindex \key2\
188 @findex \command\
189 @iftex
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
191 @end iftex
192 @ifnottex
193 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
194 @end ifnottex
195 @end ifset
196 @ifclear cmdnames
197 @kindex \key1\
198 @kindex \key2\
199 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
200 @end ifclear
201 @end macro
202
203 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
204 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
205 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
206 @ifset cmdnames
207 @kindex \key1\
208 @kindex \key2\
209 @findex \command\
210 @iftex
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
212 @end iftex
213 @ifnottex
214 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
215 @end ifnottex
216 @end ifset
217 @ifclear cmdnames
218 @kindex \key1\
219 @kindex \key2\
220 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
221 @end ifclear
222 @end macro
223
224 @c two keys with two commands
225 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
226 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
227 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
228 @ifset cmdnames
229 @kindex \key1\
230 @kindex \key2\
231 @findex \command1\
232 @findex \command2\
233 @iftex
234 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
235 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
236 @end iftex
237 @ifnottex
238 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
239 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
240 @end ifnottex
241 @end ifset
242 @ifclear cmdnames
243 @kindex \key1\
244 @kindex \key2\
245 @item @kbd{\key1\}
246 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
247 @end ifclear
248 @end macro
249 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
250
251 @iftex
252 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
253 @end iftex
254
255 @c Subheadings inside a table.
256 @macro tsubheading{text}
257 @ifinfo
258 @subsubheading \text\
259 @end ifinfo
260 @ifnotinfo
261 @item @b{\text\}
262 @end ifnotinfo
263 @end macro
264
265 @copying
266 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
267
268 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
269 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
270
271 @quotation
272 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
273 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
274 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
275 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
276 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
277 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
278
279 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
280 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
281 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
282
283 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
284 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
285 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
286 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
287 @end quotation
288 @end copying
289
290 @dircategory Emacs
291 @direntry
292 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
293 @end direntry
294
295 @titlepage
296 @title The Org Manual
297
298 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
299 @author by Carsten Dominik
300 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, and Thomas Dye
301
302 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
303 @page
304 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
305 @insertcopying
306 @end titlepage
307
308 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
309 @contents
310
311 @ifnottex
312 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
313 @top Org Mode Manual
314
315 @insertcopying
316 @end ifnottex
317
318 @menu
319 * Introduction:: Getting started
320 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
321 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
322 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
323 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
324 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
325 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
326 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
327 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
328 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
329 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
330 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
331 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
332 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
333 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
334 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
335 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
336 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
337 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
338 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
339 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
340 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
341
342 @detailmenu
343 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
344
345 Introduction
346
347 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
348 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
349 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
350 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
351 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
352
353 Document structure
354
355 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
356 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
357 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
358 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
359 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
360 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
361 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
362 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
363 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
364 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
365 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
366
367 Tables
368
369 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
370 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
371 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
372 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
373 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
374 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
375
376 The spreadsheet
377
378 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
379 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
380 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
381 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
382 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
383 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
384 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
385 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
386
387 Hyperlinks
388
389 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
390 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
391 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
392 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
393 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
394 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
395 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
396 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
397
398 Internal links
399
400 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
401
402 TODO items
403
404 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
405 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
406 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
407 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
408 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
409 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
410
411 Extended use of TODO keywords
412
413 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
414 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
415 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
416 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
417 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
418 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
419 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
420
421 Progress logging
422
423 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
424 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
425 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
426
427 Tags
428
429 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
430 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
431 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
432
433 Properties and columns
434
435 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
436 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
437 * Property searches:: Matching property values
438 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
439 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
440 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
441
442 Column view
443
444 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
445 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
446 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
447
448 Defining columns
449
450 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
451 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
452
453 Dates and times
454
455 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
456 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
457 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
458 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
459 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
460 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
461 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
462
463 Creating timestamps
464
465 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
466 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
467
468 Deadlines and scheduling
469
470 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
471 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
472
473 Clocking work time
474
475 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
476 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
477 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
478
479 Capture - Refile - Archive
480
481 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
482 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
483 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
484 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
485 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
486 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
487
488 Capture
489
490 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
491 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
492 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
493
494 Capture templates
495
496 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
497 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
498
499 Archiving
500
501 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
502 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
503
504 Agenda views
505
506 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
507 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
508 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
509 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
510 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
511 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
512 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
513 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
514
515 The built-in agenda views
516
517 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
518 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
519 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
520 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
521 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
522 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
523
524 Presentation and sorting
525
526 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
527 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
528 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
529
530 Custom agenda views
531
532 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
533 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
534 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
535
536 Markup for rich export
537
538 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
539 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
540 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
541 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
542 * Index entries:: Making an index
543 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
544 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
545
546 Structural markup elements
547
548 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
549 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
550 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
551 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
552 * Lists:: Lists
553 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
554 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
555 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
556 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
557 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
558
559 Embedded @LaTeX{}
560
561 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
562 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
563 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
564 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
565 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
566
567 Exporting
568
569 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
570 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
571 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
572 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
573 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
574 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
575 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
576 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
577 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
578 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
579 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
580
581 HTML export
582
583 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
584 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
585 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
586 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
587 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
588 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
589 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
590 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
591 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
592
593 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
594
595 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
596 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
597 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
598 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
599 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
600 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
601
602 DocBook export
603
604 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
605 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
606 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
607 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
608 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
609 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
610
611 Publishing
612
613 * Configuration:: Defining projects
614 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
615 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
616 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
617
618 Configuration
619
620 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
621 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
622 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
623 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
624 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
625 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
626 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
627 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
628
629 Sample configuration
630
631 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
632 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
633
634 Working with source code
635
636 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
637 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
638 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
639 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
640 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
641 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
642 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
643 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
644 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
645 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
646 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
647 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
648
649 Header arguments
650
651 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
652 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
653
654 Using header arguments
655
656 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
657 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
658 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
659 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
660 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
661 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
662
663 Specific header arguments
664
665 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
666 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
667 be collected and handled
668 * file:: Specify a path for file output
669 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
670 directory for code block execution
671 * exports:: Export code and/or results
672 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
673 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
674 code files
675 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
676 expansion during tangling
677 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
678 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
679 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
680 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
681 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
682 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
683 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
684 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
685
686 Miscellaneous
687
688 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
689 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
690 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
691 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
692 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
693 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
694 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
695 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
696 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
697 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
698
699 Interaction with other packages
700
701 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
702 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
703
704 Hacking
705
706 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
707 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
708 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
709 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
710 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
711 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
712 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
713 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
714 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
715 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
716
717 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
718
719 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
720 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
721 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
722 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
723
724 MobileOrg
725
726 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
727 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
728 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
729
730 @end detailmenu
731 @end menu
732
733 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
734 @chapter Introduction
735 @cindex introduction
736
737 @menu
738 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
739 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
740 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
741 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
742 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
743 @end menu
744
745 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
746 @section Summary
747 @cindex summary
748
749 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
750 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
751
752 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
753 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
754 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
755 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
756 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
757 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
758 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
759 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
760 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
761 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
762 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
763 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
764 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
765 linked web pages.
766
767 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
768 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
769 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
770
771 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
772 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
773 documentation, and tangling.
774
775 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
776 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
777 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
778 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
779 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
780 the minor Orgstruct mode.
781
782 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
783 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
784 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
785 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
786 ends, for example:
787
788 @example
789 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
790 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
791 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
792 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
793 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
794 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
795 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
796 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
797 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
798 @end example
799
800
801 @cindex FAQ
802 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
803 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
804 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
805 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
806
807 @page
808
809
810 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
811 @section Installation
812 @cindex installation
813 @cindex XEmacs
814
815 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
816 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
817 to @ref{Activation}.}
818
819 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
820 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
821 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
822 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
823 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
824 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
825 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
826 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
827 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
828
829 @example
830 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
831 @end example
832
833 @noindent
834 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
835 step for this directory:
836
837 @example
838 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
839 @end example
840
841 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
842
843 @example
844 make
845 @end example
846
847 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
848 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
849 administrator)
850
851 @example
852 make install
853 @end example
854
855 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
856 @file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
857 correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
858 systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
859 @file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
860 documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
861
862 @example
863 make install-info
864 make install-info-debian
865 @end example
866
867 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
868 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
869 when Org-mode starts.
870 @lisp
871 (require 'org-install)
872 @end lisp
873
874 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
875 @page
876
877 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
878 @section Activation
879 @cindex activation
880 @cindex autoload
881 @cindex global key bindings
882 @cindex key bindings, global
883
884 Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
885 define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
886 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb}---please choose suitable
887 keys yourself.
888
889 @lisp
890 ;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
891 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
892 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
893 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
894 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
895 @end lisp
896
897 Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
898 buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
899 active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
900 (XEmacs users must use the second option):
901 @lisp
902 (global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
903 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
904 @end lisp
905
906 @cindex Org-mode, turning on
907 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
908 into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
909 like this:
910
911 @example
912 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
913 @end example
914
915 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
916 @noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what
917 the file's name is. See also the variable
918 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
919
920 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
921 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
922 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
923 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
924 @lisp
925 (transient-mark-mode 1)
926 @end lisp
927 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
928 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
929 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
930
931 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
932 @section Feedback
933 @cindex feedback
934 @cindex bug reports
935 @cindex maintainer
936 @cindex author
937
938 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
939 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
940 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
941 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
942 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
943 moderators have to do.}.
944
945 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
946 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
947 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
948 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
949 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
950 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
951 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
952 @example
953 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
954 @end example
955 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
956 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
957 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
958
959 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
960 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
961 about:
962
963 @enumerate
964 @item What exactly did you do?
965 @item What did you expect to happen?
966 @item What happened instead?
967 @end enumerate
968 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
969
970 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
971
972 @cindex backtrace of an error
973 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
974 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
975 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
976 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
977 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
978
979 @enumerate
980 @item
981 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
982 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
983 To do this, use
984 @example
985 C-u M-x org-reload RET
986 @end example
987 @noindent
988 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
989 menu.
990 @item
991 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
992 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
993 @item
994 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
995 document the steps you take.
996 @item
997 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
998 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
999 attach it to your bug report.
1000 @end enumerate
1001
1002 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1003 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1004
1005 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
1006 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1007
1008 @table @code
1009 @item TODO
1010 @itemx WAITING
1011 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1012 user-defined.
1013 @item boss
1014 @itemx ARCHIVE
1015 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1016 meaning are written with all capitals.
1017 @item Release
1018 @itemx PRIORITY
1019 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1020 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1021 @end table
1022
1023 The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing
1024 functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions,
1025 depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic
1026 name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever possible,
1027 give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For
1028 example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will be
1029 listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it will
1030 be listed to call org-table-move-column-right.
1031
1032 If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names by
1033 unsetting the flag @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1034
1035 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1036 @chapter Document structure
1037 @cindex document structure
1038 @cindex structure of document
1039
1040 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1041 edit the structure of the document.
1042
1043 @menu
1044 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1045 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1046 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1047 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1048 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1049 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1050 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1051 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1052 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1053 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1054 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1055 @end menu
1056
1057 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1058 @section Outlines
1059 @cindex outlines
1060 @cindex Outline mode
1061
1062 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1063 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1064 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1065 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1066 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1067 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1068 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1069 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1070
1071 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1072 @section Headlines
1073 @cindex headlines
1074 @cindex outline tree
1075 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1076 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1077 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1078
1079 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1080 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1081 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1082 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1083 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
1084
1085 @example
1086 * Top level headline
1087 ** Second level
1088 *** 3rd level
1089 some text
1090 *** 3rd level
1091 more text
1092
1093 * Another top level headline
1094 @end example
1095
1096 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1097 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1098 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1099
1100 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1101 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1102 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1103 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1104 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1105 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1106
1107 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1108 @section Visibility cycling
1109 @cindex cycling, visibility
1110 @cindex visibility cycling
1111 @cindex trees, visibility
1112 @cindex show hidden text
1113 @cindex hide text
1114
1115 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1116 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1117 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1118
1119 @cindex subtree visibility states
1120 @cindex subtree cycling
1121 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1122 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1123 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1124 @table @asis
1125 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1126 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1127
1128 @example
1129 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1130 '-----------------------------------'
1131 @end example
1132
1133 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1134 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1135 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1136 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1137 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1138 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1139 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1140 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1141
1142 @cindex global visibility states
1143 @cindex global cycling
1144 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1145 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1146 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1147 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1148 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1149 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1150
1151 @example
1152 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1153 '--------------------------------------'
1154 @end example
1155
1156 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1157 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1158 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1159
1160 @cindex show all, command
1161 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1162 Show all, including drawers.
1163 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1164 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1165 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1166 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1167 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1168 level, all sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
1169 subtree of the parent.
1170 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1171 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1172 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1173 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1174 buffer
1175 @ifinfo
1176 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1177 @end ifinfo
1178 @ifnotinfo
1179 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1180 @end ifnotinfo
1181 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1182 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1183 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1184 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1185 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1186 the previously used indirect buffer.
1187 @end table
1188
1189 @vindex org-startup-folded
1190 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1191 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1192 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1193 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1194
1195 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1196 OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1197 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1198 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1199 buffer:
1200
1201 @example
1202 #+STARTUP: overview
1203 #+STARTUP: content
1204 #+STARTUP: showall
1205 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1206 @end example
1207
1208 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1209 @noindent
1210 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1211 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1212 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1213 @code{all}.
1214 @table @asis
1215 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1216 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
1217 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1218 entries.
1219 @end table
1220
1221 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1222 @section Motion
1223 @cindex motion, between headlines
1224 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1225 @cindex headline navigation
1226 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1227
1228 @table @asis
1229 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1230 Next heading.
1231 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1232 Previous heading.
1233 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1234 Next heading same level.
1235 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1236 Previous heading same level.
1237 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1238 Backward to higher level heading.
1239 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1240 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1241 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1242 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1243 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1244 @example
1245 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1246 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1247 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1248 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1249 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1250 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1251 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1252 u @r{One level up.}
1253 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1254 q @r{Quit}
1255 @end example
1256 @vindex org-goto-interface
1257 @noindent
1258 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1259 @end table
1260
1261 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1262 @section Structure editing
1263 @cindex structure editing
1264 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1265 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1266 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1267 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1268 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1269 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1270 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1271 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1272 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1273
1274 @table @asis
1275 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1276 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1277 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
1278 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
1279 creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
1280 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
1281 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
1282 the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
1283 customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
1284 command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
1285 created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
1286 the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
1287 used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
1288 of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
1289 after the end of the subtree.
1290 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1291 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1292 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1293 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1294 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1295 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1296 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1297 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1298 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1299 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1300 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1301 subtree.
1302 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1303 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1304 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1305 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1306 to the initial level.
1307 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1308 Promote current heading by one level.
1309 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1310 Demote current heading by one level.
1311 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1312 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1313 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1314 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1315 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1316 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1317 level).
1318 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1319 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1320 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1321 Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1322 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1323 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1324 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1325 sequential subtrees.
1326 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1327 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1328 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1329 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1330 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1331 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1332 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1333 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1334 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1335 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1336 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1337 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1338 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1339 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1340 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1341 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1342 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1343 folding.
1344 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1345 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1346 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1347 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1348 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1349 more details, see the docstring of the command
1350 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1351 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1352 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1353 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort-entries-or-items}
1354 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1355 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1356 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1357 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1358 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1359 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1360 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1361 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1362 sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
1363 entries will also be removed.
1364 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1365 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1366 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1367 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1368 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1369 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1370 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1371 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1372 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1373 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1374 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1375 @end table
1376
1377 @cindex region, active
1378 @cindex active region
1379 @cindex transient mark mode
1380 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1381 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1382 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1383 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1384 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1385 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1386 functionality.
1387
1388
1389 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1390 @section Sparse trees
1391 @cindex sparse trees
1392 @cindex trees, sparse
1393 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1394 @cindex occur, command
1395
1396 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1397 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1398 @vindex org-show-siblings
1399 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1400 An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1401 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1402 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1403 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1404 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1405 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1406 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1407 and you will see immediately how it works.
1408
1409 Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1410 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1411
1412 @table @asis
1413 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1414 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1415 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1416 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1417 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1418 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1419 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1420 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1421 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1422 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1423 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1424 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1425 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1426 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1427 @end table
1428
1429 @noindent
1430 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1431 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1432 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1433 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1434 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1435 For example:
1436
1437 @lisp
1438 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1439 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1440 @end lisp
1441
1442 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1443 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1444
1445 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1446 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1447
1448 @kindex C-c C-e v
1449 @cindex printing sparse trees
1450 @cindex visible text, printing
1451 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1452 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1453 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1454 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1455 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1456 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1457
1458 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1459 @section Plain lists
1460 @cindex plain lists
1461 @cindex lists, plain
1462 @cindex lists, ordered
1463 @cindex ordered lists
1464
1465 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1466 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1467 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1468 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1469
1470 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1471 @itemize @bullet
1472 @item
1473 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1474 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1475 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1476 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1477 visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1478 @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1479 as bullets.
1480 @item
1481 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1482 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1483 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1484 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1485 @samp{1)}. If you want a list to start with a different value (e.g. 20), start
1486 the text of the item with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the
1487 item, the cookie must be put @emph{before} the checkbox.}. Those constructs
1488 can be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular
1489 numbering.
1490 @item
1491 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1492 separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
1493 description.
1494 @end itemize
1495
1496 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1497 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1498 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1499 list.
1500
1501 @vindex org-list-ending-method
1502 @vindex org-list-end-regexp
1503 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1504 Two methods@footnote{To disable either of them, configure
1505 @code{org-list-ending-method}.} are provided to terminate lists. A list ends
1506 before the next line that is indented like the bullet/number or less, or it
1507 ends before two blank lines@footnote{See also
1508 @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In both cases, all levels of
1509 the list are closed@footnote{So you cannot have a sublist, some text and then
1510 another sublist while still in the same top-level list item. This used to be
1511 possible, but it was only supported in the HTML exporter and difficult to
1512 manage with automatic indentation.}. For finer control, you can end lists
1513 with any pattern set in @code{org-list-end-regexp}. Here is an example:
1514
1515 @example
1516 @group
1517 ** Lord of the Rings
1518 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1519 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1520 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1521 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1522 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1523 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1524 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1525 - on DVD only
1526 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1527 Important actors in this film are:
1528 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1529 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1530 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1531 @end group
1532 @end example
1533
1534 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1535 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1536 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1537 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1538 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1539 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1540 blocks can be indented to signal that they should be considered as a list
1541 item.
1542
1543 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1544 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1545 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1546 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}.
1547
1548 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1549 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1550 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1551 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1552 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1553 to disable them individually.
1554
1555 @table @asis
1556 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1557 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1558 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1559 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1560 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1561 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1562 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the
1563 indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
1564 headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
1565 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1566 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1567 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1568 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1569 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1570 of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1571 item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1572 @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed @emph{before
1573 an item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current item. If the
1574 command is executed in the white space before the text that is part of an
1575 item but does not contain the bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
1576
1577 As a new item cannot be inserted in a structural construct (like an example
1578 or source code block) within a list, Org will instead insert it right before
1579 the structure, or return an error.
1580 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1581 @item M-S-@key{RET}
1582 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1583 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1584 In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
1585 become a child of the previous one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to
1586 meaningful levels in the list and eventually get it back to its initial
1587 position.
1588 @kindex S-@key{down}
1589 @item S-@key{up}
1590 @itemx S-@key{down}
1591 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1592 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1593 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
1594 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1595 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1596 similar effect.
1597 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1598 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1599 @item M-S-@key{up}
1600 @itemx M-S-@key{down}
1601 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1602 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1603 automatic.
1604 @kindex M-@key{left}
1605 @kindex M-@key{right}
1606 @item M-@key{left}
1607 @itemx M-@key{right}
1608 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1609 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1610 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1611 @item M-S-@key{left}
1612 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1613 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1614 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1615 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1616 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1617 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1618 motion or so.
1619
1620 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1621 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1622 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1623 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1624 @kindex C-c C-c
1625 @item C-c C-c
1626 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1627 state of the checkbox. Also, makes sure that all the
1628 items on this list level use the same bullet and that the numbering of list
1629 items (if applicable) is correct.
1630 @kindex C-c -
1631 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1632 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1633 @item C-c -
1634 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1635 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1636 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1637 and its position@footnote{See @code{bullet} rule in
1638 @code{org-list-automatic-rules} for more information.}. With a numeric
1639 prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
1640 active region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items.
1641 If the first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed
1642 from the list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1643 converted into a list item.
1644 @kindex C-c *
1645 @item C-c *
1646 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1647 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1648 @kindex S-@key{left}
1649 @kindex S-@key{right}
1650 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1651 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1652 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1653 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1654 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1655 @kindex C-c ^
1656 @item C-c ^
1657 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1658 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1659 @end table
1660
1661 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1662 @section Drawers
1663 @cindex drawers
1664 @cindex #+DRAWERS
1665 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1666
1667 @vindex org-drawers
1668 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1669 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}.
1670 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1671 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1672 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1673 look like this:
1674
1675 @example
1676 ** This is a headline
1677 Still outside the drawer
1678 :DRAWERNAME:
1679 This is inside the drawer.
1680 :END:
1681 After the drawer.
1682 @end example
1683
1684 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1685 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1686 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1687 press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1688 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1689 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1690 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1691 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1692
1693 @table @kbd
1694 @kindex C-c C-z
1695 @item C-c C-z
1696 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1697 @end table
1698
1699 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1700 @section Blocks
1701
1702 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1703 @cindex blocks, folding
1704 Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1705 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1706 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1707 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1708 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1709 or on a per-file basis by using
1710
1711 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1712 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1713 @example
1714 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1715 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1716 @end example
1717
1718 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1719 @section Footnotes
1720 @cindex footnotes
1721
1722 Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1723 @file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1724 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1725 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
1726 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1727 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1728 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1729 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1730
1731 @example
1732 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1733 ...
1734 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1735 @end example
1736
1737 Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1738 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1739 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1740 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1741 LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
1742
1743 @table @code
1744 @item [1]
1745 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1746 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1747 snippet.
1748 @item [fn:name]
1749 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1750 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1751 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1752 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1753 reference point.
1754 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1755 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1756 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1757 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1758 @end table
1759
1760 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1761 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1762 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1763 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1764 for details.
1765
1766 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1767
1768 @table @kbd
1769 @kindex C-c C-x f
1770 @item C-c C-x f
1771 The footnote action command.
1772
1773 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1774 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1775
1776 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1777 @vindex org-footnote-section
1778 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1779 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1780 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1781 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1782 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1783 separately into the location determined by the variable
1784 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1785
1786 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1787 options is offered:
1788 @example
1789 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1790 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1791 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1792 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1793 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1794 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1795 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1796 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1797 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1798 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1799 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1800 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1801 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1802 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
1803 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1804 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1805 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1806 @r{to it.}
1807 @end example
1808 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1809 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1810 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1811 deletion.
1812
1813 @kindex C-c C-c
1814 @item C-c C-c
1815 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1816 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1817 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1818 @kindex C-c C-o
1819 @kindex mouse-1
1820 @kindex mouse-2
1821 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1822 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1823 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1824 @end table
1825
1826 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1827 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1828 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1829 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1830
1831 If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
1832 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1833 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1834 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1835 turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
1836
1837 @lisp
1838 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1839 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1840 @end lisp
1841
1842 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1843 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1844 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1845 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1846 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1847 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1848 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1849 item.
1850
1851 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1852 @chapter Tables
1853 @cindex tables
1854 @cindex editing tables
1855
1856 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1857 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
1858 @ifinfo
1859 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1860 @end ifinfo
1861 @ifnotinfo
1862 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1863 calculator).
1864 @end ifnotinfo
1865
1866 @menu
1867 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1868 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1869 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1870 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1871 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1872 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1873 @end menu
1874
1875 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1876 @section The built-in table editor
1877 @cindex table editor, built-in
1878
1879 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
1880 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1881 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1882 this:
1883
1884 @example
1885 | Name | Phone | Age |
1886 |-------+-------+-----|
1887 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1888 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1889 @end example
1890
1891 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1892 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1893 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1894 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1895 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1896 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1897 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1898 create the above table, you would only type
1899
1900 @example
1901 |Name|Phone|Age|
1902 |-
1903 @end example
1904
1905 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1906 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1907 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1908
1909 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
1910 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
1911 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1912 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1913 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1914 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1915 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1916 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1917 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1918 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1919
1920 @table @kbd
1921 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1922 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
1923 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1924 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1925 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1926 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1927 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1928 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1929 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1930 @*
1931 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1932 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1933 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1934
1935 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1936 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
1937 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1938 @c
1939 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
1940 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1941 necessary.
1942 @c
1943 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
1944 Re-align, move to previous field.
1945 @c
1946 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
1947 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1948 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1949 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1950 @c
1951 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
1952 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
1953 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
1954 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
1955
1956 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1957 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
1958 Move the current column left/right.
1959 @c
1960 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
1961 Kill the current column.
1962 @c
1963 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
1964 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1965 @c
1966 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
1967 Move the current row up/down.
1968 @c
1969 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
1970 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1971 @c
1972 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
1973 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1974 created below the current one.
1975 @c
1976 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
1977 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
1978 is created above the current line.
1979 @c
1980 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
1981 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
1982 below that line.
1983 @c
1984 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
1985 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
1986 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
1987 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
1988 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
1989 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
1990 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
1991 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
1992 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
1993 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
1994
1995 @tsubheading{Regions}
1996 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
1997 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
1998 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
1999 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2000 @c
2001 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2002 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2003 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2004 @c
2005 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2006 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2007 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2008 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2009 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2010 lines.
2011 @c
2012 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2013 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2014 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2015 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2016 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2017 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2018 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2019 above.
2020
2021 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2022 @cindex formula, in tables
2023 @cindex calculations, in tables
2024 @cindex region, active
2025 @cindex active region
2026 @cindex transient mark mode
2027 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2028 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2029 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2030 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2031 @c
2032 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2033 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2034 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2035 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2036 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2037 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2038 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2039 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2040 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2041
2042 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2043 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2044 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2045 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2046 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2047 edited in place.
2048 @c
2049 @item M-x org-table-import
2050 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2051 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2052 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2053 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2054 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2055 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2056 separator.
2057 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2058 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2059 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2060 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2061 @c
2062 @item M-x org-table-export
2063 @findex org-table-export
2064 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2065 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2066 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2067 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2068 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2069 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2070 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2071 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2072 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2073 detailed description.
2074 @end table
2075
2076 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2077 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2078 it off with
2079
2080 @lisp
2081 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2082 @end lisp
2083
2084 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2085 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2086
2087 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2088 @section Column width and alignment
2089 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2090 @cindex alignment in tables
2091
2092 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2093 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2094 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2095
2096 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2097 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2098 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2099 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2100 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2101 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2102 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2103
2104 @example
2105 @group
2106 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2107 | | | | | <6> |
2108 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2109 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2110 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2111 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2112 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2113 @end group
2114 @end example
2115
2116 @noindent
2117 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2118 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2119 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2120 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2121 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2122 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2123 C-c}.
2124
2125 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2126 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2127 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2128 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2129 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2130 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2131 on a per-file basis with:
2132
2133 @example
2134 #+STARTUP: align
2135 #+STARTUP: noalign
2136 @end example
2137
2138 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2139 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2140 @samp{c}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2141 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2142 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2143
2144 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2145 automatically when exporting the document.
2146
2147 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2148 @section Column groups
2149 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2150
2151 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2152 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2153 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2154 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2155 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2156 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2157 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2158 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
2159 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2160 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2161
2162 @example
2163 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2164 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2165 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2166 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2167 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2168 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2169 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2170 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2171 @end example
2172
2173 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2174 every vertical line you would like to have:
2175
2176 @example
2177 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2178 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2179 | / | < | | | < | |
2180 @end example
2181
2182 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2183 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2184 @cindex Orgtbl mode
2185 @cindex minor mode for tables
2186
2187 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2188 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2189 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2190 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2191 example in mail mode, use
2192
2193 @lisp
2194 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2195 @end lisp
2196
2197 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2198 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2199 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2200 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2201 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2202
2203 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2204 @section The spreadsheet
2205 @cindex calculations, in tables
2206 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2207 @cindex @file{calc} package
2208
2209 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2210 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2211 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2212 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2213 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2214 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2215 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2216 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2217 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2218
2219 @menu
2220 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2221 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2222 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2223 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
2224 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2225 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2226 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2227 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
2228 @end menu
2229
2230 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2231 @subsection References
2232 @cindex references
2233
2234 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2235 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2236 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2237 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2238 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2239
2240 @subsubheading Field references
2241 @cindex field references
2242 @cindex references, to fields
2243
2244 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2245 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2246 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2247 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
2248 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
2249 @c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
2250
2251 @noindent
2252 Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
2253 @example
2254 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2255 @end example
2256
2257 @noindent
2258 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
2259 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
2260
2261 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
2262 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
2263 @samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
2264 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
2265 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
2266 hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
2267 starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
2268 the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
2269 current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
2270 You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
2271 third hline in the table.
2272
2273 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
2274 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
2275 row/column is implied.
2276
2277 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2278 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2279 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2280 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2281 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2282 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2283
2284 As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
2285 to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
2286 table.
2287
2288 Here are a few examples:
2289
2290 @example
2291 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
2292 C2 @r{same as previous}
2293 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
2294 E& @r{same as previous}
2295 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2296 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2297 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2298 @end example
2299
2300 @subsubheading Range references
2301 @cindex range references
2302 @cindex references, to ranges
2303
2304 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2305 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2306 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2307 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2308 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2309 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2310
2311 @example
2312 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
2313 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2314 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
2315 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
2316 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2317 @end example
2318
2319 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2320 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2321 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2322 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2323 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2324
2325 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2326 @cindex field coordinates
2327 @cindex coordinates, of field
2328 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2329 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2330
2331 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2332 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2333 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2334 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2335
2336 @example
2337 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2338 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2339 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2340 @end example
2341
2342 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2343 as the current table. Inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2344 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2345 number of rows.
2346
2347 @subsubheading Named references
2348 @cindex named references
2349 @cindex references, named
2350 @cindex name, of column or field
2351 @cindex constants, in calculations
2352 @cindex #+CONSTANTS
2353
2354 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2355 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2356 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2357 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2358 line like
2359
2360 @example
2361 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2362 @end example
2363
2364 @noindent
2365 @vindex constants-unit-system
2366 @pindex constants.el
2367 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2368 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2369 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2370 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2371 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2372 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2373 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2374 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2375 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2376 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2377 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2378 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2379 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2380 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2381 numbers.
2382
2383 @subsubheading Remote references
2384 @cindex remote references
2385 @cindex references, remote
2386 @cindex references, to a different table
2387 @cindex name, of column or field
2388 @cindex constants, in calculations
2389 @cindex #+TBLNAME
2390
2391 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2392 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2393
2394 @example
2395 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2396 @end example
2397
2398 @noindent
2399 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2400 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2401 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2402 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2403 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2404 referenced table.
2405
2406 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2407 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2408 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2409 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2410
2411 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2412 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2413 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2414 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2415 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2416 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2417 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2418 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2419 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2420 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2421 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2422 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2423
2424 @cindex format specifier
2425 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2426 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2427 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2428 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2429 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2430 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2431 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2432 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2433 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2434
2435 @example
2436 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2437 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2438 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2439 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2440 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2441 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2442 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2443 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2444 T @r{force text interpretation}
2445 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2446 L @r{literal}
2447 @end example
2448
2449 @noindent
2450 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2451 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2452 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2453 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2454 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2455 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2456 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2457 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2458 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2459 A few examples:
2460
2461 @example
2462 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2463 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2464 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2465 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2466 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2467 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2468 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2469 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2470 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2471 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2472 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2473 @end example
2474
2475 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2476
2477 @example
2478 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2479 @end example
2480
2481 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2482 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2483 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2484
2485 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful for
2486 string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is not
2487 enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening
2488 parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should
2489 return either a string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you
2490 can specify modes and a printf format after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp
2491 forms, you need to be conscious about the way field references are
2492 interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be interpolated as
2493 a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the
2494 @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers (non-number
2495 fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If
2496 you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally,
2497 without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string
2498 by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes,
2499 like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2500 +embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a few examples---note how the
2501 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp:
2502
2503 @example
2504 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2505 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2506 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2507 '(+ $1 $2);N
2508 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2509 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2510 @end example
2511
2512 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2513 @subsection Field formulas
2514 @cindex field formula
2515 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2516
2517 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2518 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2519 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
2520 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
2521 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
2522
2523 @cindex #+TBLFM
2524 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2525 directly below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of
2526 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2527 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2528 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2529 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
2530 same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
2531 with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2532 The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
2533 features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2534
2535 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2536 following command
2537
2538 @table @kbd
2539 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2540 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2541 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2542 it to the current field, and stores it.
2543 @end table
2544
2545 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2546 @subsection Column formulas
2547 @cindex column formula
2548 @cindex formula, for table column
2549
2550 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2551 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2552 in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
2553 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2554 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2555 and will not be modified by column formulas.
2556
2557 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2558 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2559 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2560 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2561 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2562 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2563 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2564 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
2565 side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
2566 must be the numeric column reference.
2567
2568 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2569 following command:
2570
2571 @table @kbd
2572 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2573 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2574 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2575 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2576 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2577 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2578 @end table
2579
2580 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2581 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2582 @cindex formula editing
2583 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2584
2585 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2586 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2587 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2588 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2589 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2590 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2591 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2592 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2593
2594 @table @kbd
2595 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2596 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2597 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
2598 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2599 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2600 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2601 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2602 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2603 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2604 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2605 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2606 @kindex C-c @}
2607 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2608 @item C-c @}
2609 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2610 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2611 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2612 @kindex C-c @{
2613 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2614 @item C-c @{
2615 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2616 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2617 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2618 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2619 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2620 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2621 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2622 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2623 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2624 @table @kbd
2625 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2626 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2627 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2628 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2629 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2630 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2631 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2632 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2633 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2634 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2635 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2636 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2637 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2638 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2639 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2640 @kindex S-@key{up}
2641 @kindex S-@key{down}
2642 @kindex S-@key{left}
2643 @kindex S-@key{right}
2644 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2645 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2646 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2647 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2648 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2649 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2650 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2651 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2652 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2653 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2654 down.
2655 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2656 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2657 @kindex C-c @}
2658 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2659 @item C-c @}
2660 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2661 @end table
2662 @end table
2663
2664 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2665 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2666 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2667 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2668 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2669
2670 @kindex C-c C-c
2671 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2672 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2673 recalculation commands in the table.
2674
2675 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2676 @cindex formula debugging
2677 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2678 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2679 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2680 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2681 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2682 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2683 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2684
2685 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2686 @subsection Updating the table
2687 @cindex recomputing table fields
2688 @cindex updating, table
2689
2690 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2691 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2692 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2693
2694 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2695 following commands:
2696
2697 @table @kbd
2698 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2699 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2700 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2701 @c
2702 @kindex C-u C-c *
2703 @item C-u C-c *
2704 @kindex C-u C-c C-c
2705 @itemx C-u C-c C-c
2706 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2707 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2708 @c
2709 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2710 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2711 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2712 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2713 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2714 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2715 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2716 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2717 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2718 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2719 dependencies.
2720 @end table
2721
2722 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2723 @subsection Advanced features
2724
2725 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2726 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2727 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2728 @table @kbd
2729 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2730 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2731 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2732 change all marks in the region.
2733 @end table
2734
2735 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2736 makes use of these features:
2737
2738 @example
2739 @group
2740 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2741 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2742 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2743 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2744 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2745 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2746 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2747 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2748 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2749 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2750 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2751 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2752 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2753 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2754 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2755 @end group
2756 @end example
2757
2758 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2759 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2760 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2761 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2762 empty first field.
2763
2764 @cindex marking characters, tables
2765 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2766 @table @samp
2767 @item !
2768 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2769 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2770 @item ^
2771 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2772 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2773 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2774 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2775 @item _
2776 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2777 @emph{below}.
2778 @item $
2779 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2780 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2781 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2782 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2783 a per-table basis.
2784 @item #
2785 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2786 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2787 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2788 lines will be left alone by this command.
2789 @item *
2790 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2791 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2792 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2793 @item
2794 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2795 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2796 or @samp{*}.
2797 @item /
2798 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2799 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2800 @end table
2801
2802 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2803 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2804 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2805 functions.
2806
2807 @example
2808 @group
2809 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2810 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2811 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2812 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2813 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2814 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2815 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2816 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2817 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2818 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2819 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2820 @end group
2821 @end example
2822
2823 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2824 @section Org-Plot
2825 @cindex graph, in tables
2826 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
2827 @cindex #+PLOT
2828
2829 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2830 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2831 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2832 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
2833 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2834
2835 @example
2836 @group
2837 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2838 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2839 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2840 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2841 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2842 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2843 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2844 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2845 @end group
2846 @end example
2847
2848 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
2849 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2850 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
2851 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
2852 see the Org-plot tutorial at
2853 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
2854
2855 @subsubheading Plot Options
2856
2857 @table @code
2858 @item set
2859 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2860
2861 @item title
2862 Specify the title of the plot.
2863
2864 @item ind
2865 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2866
2867 @item deps
2868 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
2869 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2870 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
2871 column).
2872
2873 @item type
2874 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2875
2876 @item with
2877 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2878 (e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2879 Defaults to @code{lines}.
2880
2881 @item file
2882 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
2883
2884 @item labels
2885 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
2886 if they exist).
2887
2888 @item line
2889 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
2890
2891 @item map
2892 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2893 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2894
2895 @item timefmt
2896 Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
2897 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
2898
2899 @item script
2900 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
2901 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
2902 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
2903 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
2904 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2905 the data file.
2906 @end table
2907
2908 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2909 @chapter Hyperlinks
2910 @cindex hyperlinks
2911
2912 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2913 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2914
2915 @menu
2916 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2917 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2918 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
2919 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2920 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2921 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2922 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2923 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2924 @end menu
2925
2926 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2927 @section Link format
2928 @cindex link format
2929 @cindex format, of links
2930
2931 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2932 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2933
2934 @example
2935 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2936 @end example
2937
2938 @noindent
2939 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2940 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2941 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2942 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2943 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2944 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2945 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2946 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2947 cursor on the link.
2948
2949 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2950 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2951 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2952 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2953 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2954 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2955 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2956
2957 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2958 @section Internal links
2959 @cindex internal links
2960 @cindex links, internal
2961 @cindex targets, for links
2962
2963 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2964 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
2965 current file. The most important case is a link like
2966 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
2967 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
2968 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
2969 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
2970 in a file.
2971
2972 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
2973 lead to a text search in the current file.
2974
2975 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
2976 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
2977 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
2978 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
2979 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
2980 comment line. For example
2981
2982 @example
2983 # <<My Target>>
2984 @end example
2985
2986 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
2987 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
2988 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
2989 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
2990 first headline.}.
2991
2992 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
2993 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
2994 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
2995 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
2996 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
2997 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
2998 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
2999
3000 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3001 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3002 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3003 earlier.
3004
3005 @menu
3006 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3007 @end menu
3008
3009 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3010 @subsection Radio targets
3011 @cindex radio targets
3012 @cindex targets, radio
3013 @cindex links, radio targets
3014
3015 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3016 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3017 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3018 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3019 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3020 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3021 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3022 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3023 cursor on or at a target.
3024
3025 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3026 @section External links
3027 @cindex links, external
3028 @cindex external links
3029 @cindex links, external
3030 @cindex Gnus links
3031 @cindex BBDB links
3032 @cindex IRC links
3033 @cindex URL links
3034 @cindex file links
3035 @cindex VM links
3036 @cindex RMAIL links
3037 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3038 @cindex MH-E links
3039 @cindex USENET links
3040 @cindex SHELL links
3041 @cindex Info links
3042 @cindex Elisp links
3043
3044 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3045 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3046 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3047 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3048 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3049
3050 @example
3051 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3052 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3053 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3054 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3055 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3056 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3057 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3058 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3059 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
3060 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3061 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
3062 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3063 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
3064 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3065 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3066 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3067 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3068 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3069 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3070 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3071 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3072 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3073 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3074 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3075 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3076 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3077 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3078 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3079 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3080 info:org:External%20links @r{Info node link (with encoded space)}
3081 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3082 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3083 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3084 @end example
3085
3086 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3087 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3088 format}), for example:
3089
3090 @example
3091 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3092 @end example
3093
3094 @noindent
3095 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3096 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3097 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3098 image,
3099 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3100
3101 @cindex square brackets, around links
3102 @cindex plain text external links
3103 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3104 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3105 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3106 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3107
3108 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3109 @section Handling links
3110 @cindex links, handling
3111
3112 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3113 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3114
3115 @table @kbd
3116 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3117 @cindex storing links
3118 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3119 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3120 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3121 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3122 buffer:
3123
3124 @b{Org-mode buffers}@*
3125 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3126 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3127 be the description.
3128
3129 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3130 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3131 @cindex property, ID
3132 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3133 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3134 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3135 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3136 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3137 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3138 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3139 to use.
3140
3141 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3142 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3143 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3144 constructed from the author and the subject.
3145
3146 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3147 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3148
3149 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3150 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3151
3152 @b{Chat: IRC}@*
3153 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3154 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3155 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3156 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3157 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3158
3159 @b{Other files}@*
3160 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3161 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3162 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3163 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3164 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3165 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3166 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3167
3168 @b{Agenda view}@*
3169 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3170 entry referenced by the current line.
3171
3172 @c
3173 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3174 @cindex link completion
3175 @cindex completion, of links
3176 @cindex inserting links
3177 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3178 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3179 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3180 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3181 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3182 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3183 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3184 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3185 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3186 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3187 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3188 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3189 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3190 becomes the default description.
3191
3192 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3193 All links stored during the
3194 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3195 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3196
3197 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3198 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3199 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3200 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3201 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3202 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3203 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3204 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3205 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3206 @orgkey C-u C-c C-l
3207 @cindex file name completion
3208 @cindex completion, of file names
3209 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3210 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3211 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3212 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3213 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3214 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3215 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3216 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3217 @c
3218 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3219 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3220 link and description parts of the link.
3221 @c
3222 @cindex following links
3223 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3224 @vindex org-file-apps
3225 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3226 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3227 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3228 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3229 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3230 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3231 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3232 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3233 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3234 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3235 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3236 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3237 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3238 headline and entry text.
3239 @orgkey @key{RET}
3240 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3241 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3242 the link at point.
3243 @c
3244 @kindex mouse-2
3245 @kindex mouse-1
3246 @item mouse-2
3247 @itemx mouse-1
3248 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3249 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3250 @c
3251 @kindex mouse-3
3252 @item mouse-3
3253 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3254 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3255 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3256 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3257 @c
3258 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3259 @cindex inlining images
3260 @cindex images, inlining
3261 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3262 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3263 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3264 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3265 images that have no description part in the link, i.e. images that will also
3266 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3267 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3268 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3269 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3270 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3271 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3272 @cindex mark ring
3273 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3274 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3275 @c
3276 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3277 @cindex links, returning to
3278 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3279 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3280 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3281 previously recorded positions.
3282 @c
3283 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3284 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3285 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3286 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3287 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3288 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3289 @lisp
3290 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3291 (lambda ()
3292 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3293 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3294 @end lisp
3295 @end table
3296
3297 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3298 @section Using links outside Org
3299
3300 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3301 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3302 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3303 yourself):
3304
3305 @lisp
3306 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3307 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3308 @end lisp
3309
3310 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3311 @section Link abbreviations
3312 @cindex link abbreviations
3313 @cindex abbreviation, links
3314
3315 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3316 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3317 abbreviated link looks like this
3318
3319 @example
3320 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3321 @end example
3322
3323 @noindent
3324 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3325 where the tag is optional.
3326 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3327 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3328 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3329 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3330
3331 @smalllisp
3332 @group
3333 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3334 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3335 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3336 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3337 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3338 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3339 @end group
3340 @end smalllisp
3341
3342 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3343 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3344 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3345 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3346
3347 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3348 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3349 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3350 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3351 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3352 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3353 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3354
3355 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3356 can define them in the file with
3357
3358 @cindex #+LINK
3359 @example
3360 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3361 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3362 @end example
3363
3364 @noindent
3365 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3366 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3367 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
3368 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3369 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3370
3371 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3372 @section Search options in file links
3373 @cindex search option in file links
3374 @cindex file links, searching
3375
3376 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3377 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3378 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3379 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3380 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3381 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3382 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3383 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3384
3385 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3386 link, together with an explanation:
3387
3388 @example
3389 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3390 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3391 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3392 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3393 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3394 @end example
3395
3396 @table @code
3397 @item 255
3398 Jump to line 255.
3399 @item My Target
3400 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3401 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3402 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3403 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3404 the linked file.
3405 @item *My Target
3406 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3407 @item #my-custom-id
3408 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3409 @item /regexp/
3410 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3411 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3412 target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3413 sparse tree with the matches.
3414 @c If the target file is a directory,
3415 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3416 @end table
3417
3418 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3419 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3420 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3421 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3422
3423 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3424 @section Custom Searches
3425 @cindex custom search strings
3426 @cindex search strings, custom
3427
3428 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3429 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3430 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3431 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3432 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3433 citation key.
3434
3435 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3436 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3437 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3438 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3439 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3440 to be added to the hook variables
3441 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3442 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3443 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3444 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3445 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3446
3447 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3448 @chapter TODO items
3449 @cindex TODO items
3450
3451 Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3452 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3453 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3454 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3455 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3456 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3457 item emerged is always present.
3458
3459 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3460 throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
3461 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3462
3463 @menu
3464 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3465 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3466 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3467 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3468 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3469 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3470 @end menu
3471
3472 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3473 @section Basic TODO functionality
3474
3475 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3476 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3477
3478 @example
3479 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3480 @end example
3481
3482 @noindent
3483 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3484
3485 @table @kbd
3486 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3487 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3488 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3489
3490 @example
3491 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3492 '--------------------------------'
3493 @end example
3494
3495 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3496 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3497
3498 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3499 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3500 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3501 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3502 more information.
3503
3504 @kindex S-@key{right}
3505 @kindex S-@key{left}
3506 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3507 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3508 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3509 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3510 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3511 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3512 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3513 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
3514 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3515 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3516 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3517 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3518 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3519 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3520 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3521 entries that match any one of these keywords. With numeric prefix argument
3522 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3523 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3524 both un-done and done.
3525 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3526 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3527 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3528 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3529 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3530 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3531 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3532 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3533 @end table
3534
3535 @noindent
3536 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3537 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3538 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3539
3540 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3541 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3542 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3543
3544 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3545 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3546 DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3547 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3548 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3549 files.
3550
3551 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3552 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3553
3554 @menu
3555 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3556 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3557 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3558 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3559 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3560 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3561 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3562 @end menu
3563
3564 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3565 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3566 @cindex TODO workflow
3567 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3568
3569 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3570 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3571 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a
3572 buffer.}:
3573
3574 @lisp
3575 (setq org-todo-keywords
3576 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3577 @end lisp
3578
3579 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3580 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3581 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3582 state.
3583 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3584 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3585 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3586 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3587 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3588 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3589 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3590 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3591 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3592 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3593 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3594
3595 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3596 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3597 @cindex TODO types
3598 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3599 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3600
3601 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3602 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3603 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3604 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3605 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3606 be set up like this:
3607
3608 @lisp
3609 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3610 @end lisp
3611
3612 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3613 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3614 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by adapting
3615 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3616 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3617 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3618 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3619 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3620 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3621 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3622 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3623 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3624 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3625 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3626
3627 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3628 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3629 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3630
3631 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3632 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3633 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3634 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3635 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3636 like this:
3637
3638 @lisp
3639 (setq org-todo-keywords
3640 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3641 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3642 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3643 @end lisp
3644
3645 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track
3646 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3647 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3648 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3649 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3650 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3651 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3652
3653 @table @kbd
3654 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3655 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3656 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3657 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3658 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3659 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3660 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3661 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3662 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3663 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3664 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3665 @kindex S-@key{right}
3666 @kindex S-@key{left}
3667 @item S-@key{right}
3668 @itemx S-@key{left}
3669 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3670 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3671 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3672 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3673 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3674 @end table
3675
3676 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3677 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3678
3679 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3680 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3681 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3682 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3683
3684 @lisp
3685 (setq org-todo-keywords
3686 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3687 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3688 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3689 @end lisp
3690
3691 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3692 If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3693 will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3694 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3695 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3696 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3697 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3698 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3699
3700 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3701 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3702 @cindex keyword options
3703 @cindex per-file keywords
3704 @cindex #+TODO
3705 @cindex #+TYP_TODO
3706 @cindex #+SEQ_TODO
3707
3708 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3709 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3710 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3711 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3712 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3713 file:
3714
3715 @example
3716 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3717 @end example
3718 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3719 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3720 @example
3721 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3722 @end example
3723
3724 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3725
3726 @example
3727 #+TODO: TODO | DONE
3728 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3729 #+TODO: | CANCELED
3730 @end example
3731
3732 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3733 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
3734 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3735 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3736
3737 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3738 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3739 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3740 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3741 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3742 known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when
3743 Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3744 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode
3745 for the current buffer.}.
3746
3747 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3748 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3749 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3750
3751 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3752 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3753 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3754 Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3755 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3756 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3757 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3758 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3759 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3760
3761 @lisp
3762 @group
3763 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3764 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3765 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3766 @end group
3767 @end lisp
3768
3769 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3770 work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3771 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3772 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3773 foreground or a background color.
3774
3775 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3776 @subsection TODO dependencies
3777 @cindex TODO dependencies
3778 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3779
3780 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3781 @cindex property, ORDERED
3782 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3783 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3784 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3785 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3786 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3787 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3788 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3789 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3790 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3791 example:
3792
3793 @example
3794 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3795 ** DONE one
3796 ** TODO two
3797
3798 * Parent
3799 :PROPERTIES:
3800 :ORDERED: t
3801 :END:
3802 ** TODO a
3803 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3804 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3805 @end example
3806
3807 @table @kbd
3808 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
3809 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3810 @cindex property, ORDERED
3811 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3812 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3813 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3814 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3815 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3816 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
3817 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
3818 @end table
3819
3820 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
3821 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3822 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3823 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3824
3825 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
3826 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3827 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3828 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3829 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3830 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3831
3832 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3833 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3834 module @file{org-depend.el}.
3835
3836 @page
3837 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3838 @section Progress logging
3839 @cindex progress logging
3840 @cindex logging, of progress
3841
3842 Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
3843 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3844 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3845 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3846 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3847 work time}.
3848
3849 @menu
3850 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3851 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3852 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
3853 @end menu
3854
3855 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3856 @subsection Closing items
3857
3858 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3859 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3860 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
3861
3862 @lisp
3863 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3864 @end lisp
3865
3866 @noindent
3867 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3868 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3869 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3870 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3871 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3872 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3873
3874 @lisp
3875 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3876 @end lisp
3877
3878 @noindent
3879 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3880 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3881
3882 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3883 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
3884 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3885 giving you an overview of what has been done.
3886
3887 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
3888 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
3889 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
3890
3891 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
3892 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
3893 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
3894 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
3895 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
3896 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
3897 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
3898 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
3899 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
3900 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
3901 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
3902 behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
3903 also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
3904 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
3905
3906 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org-mode
3907 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
3908 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
3909 in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
3910
3911 @lisp
3912 (setq org-todo-keywords
3913 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
3914 @end lisp
3915
3916 @noindent
3917 @vindex org-log-done
3918 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
3919 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
3920 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps
3921 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
3922 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
3923 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3924 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
3925 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
3926 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
3927 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
3928 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3929 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3930 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3931 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3932 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3933 configured.
3934
3935 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3936 to a buffer:
3937 @example
3938 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
3939 @end example
3940
3941 @cindex property, LOGGING
3942 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3943 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3944 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3945 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3946 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3947 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3948
3949 @example
3950 * TODO Log each state with only a time
3951 :PROPERTIES:
3952 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3953 :END:
3954 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3955 :PROPERTIES:
3956 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3957 :END:
3958 * TODO No logging at all
3959 :PROPERTIES:
3960 :LOGGING: nil
3961 :END:
3962 @end example
3963
3964 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
3965 @subsection Tracking your habits
3966 @cindex habits
3967
3968 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
3969 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
3970
3971 @enumerate
3972 @item
3973 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
3974 @code{org-modules}.
3975 @item
3976 The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
3977 @item
3978 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
3979 @item
3980 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
3981 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
3982 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
3983 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
3984 @item
3985 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
3986 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
3987 three days, but at most every two days.
3988 @item
3989 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
3990 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
3991 enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
3992 meaningless.
3993 @end enumerate
3994
3995 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
3996 actual habit with some history:
3997
3998 @example
3999 ** TODO Shave
4000 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4001 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4002 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4003 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4004 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4005 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4006 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4007 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4008 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4009 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4010 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4011 :PROPERTIES:
4012 :STYLE: habit
4013 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4014 :END:
4015 @end example
4016
4017 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4018 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4019 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4020 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4021 after four days have elapsed.
4022
4023 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4024 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4025 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4026 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4027
4028 @table @code
4029 @item Blue
4030 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4031 @item Green
4032 If the task could have been done on that day.
4033 @item Yellow
4034 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4035 @item Red
4036 If the task was overdue on that day.
4037 @end table
4038
4039 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4040 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4041 the current day falls in the graph.
4042
4043 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4044 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4045
4046 @table @code
4047 @item org-habit-graph-column
4048 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4049 overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
4050 titles brief and to the point.
4051 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4052 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4053 @item org-habit-following-days
4054 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4055 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4056 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4057 default.
4058 @end table
4059
4060 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4061 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4062 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4063 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4064
4065 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4066 @section Priorities
4067 @cindex priorities
4068
4069 If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4070 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4071 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4072
4073 @example
4074 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4075 @end example
4076
4077 @noindent
4078 @vindex org-priority-faces
4079 By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4080 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4081 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4082 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4083 have no inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4084 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4085
4086 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4087 items.
4088
4089 @table @kbd
4090 @item @kbd{C-c ,}
4091 @kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
4092 @findex org-priority
4093 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4094 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4095 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4096 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4097 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4098 @c
4099 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4100 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4101 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4102 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4103 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4104 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4105 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4106 @end table
4107
4108 @vindex org-highest-priority
4109 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4110 @vindex org-default-priority
4111 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4112 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4113 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4114 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4115 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4116 priority):
4117
4118 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4119 @example
4120 #+PRIORITIES: A C B
4121 @end example
4122
4123 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4124 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4125 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4126 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4127
4128 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4129 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4130 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4131 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4132 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4133 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4134 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4135 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4136 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4137
4138 @example
4139 * Organize Party [33%]
4140 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4141 *** TODO Peter
4142 *** DONE Sarah
4143 ** TODO Buy food
4144 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4145 @end example
4146
4147 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4148 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4149 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4150 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4151 this issue.
4152
4153 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4154 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4155 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4156 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4157 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4158 property.
4159
4160 @example
4161 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4162 :PROPERTIES:
4163 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4164 :END:
4165 @end example
4166
4167 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4168 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4169
4170 @example
4171 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4172 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4173 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4174 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4175
4176 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4177 @end example
4178
4179
4180 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4181 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4182
4183
4184 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4185 @section Checkboxes
4186 @cindex checkboxes
4187
4188 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4189 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4190 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4191 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4192 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4193 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4194 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4195 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4196 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4197 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4198
4199 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4200
4201 @example
4202 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4203 - [-] call people [1/3]
4204 - [ ] Peter
4205 - [X] Sarah
4206 - [ ] Sam
4207 - [X] order food
4208 - [ ] think about what music to play
4209 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4210 @end example
4211
4212 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4213 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4214 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4215 checked.
4216
4217 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4218 @cindex checkbox statistics
4219 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4220 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4221 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4222 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4223 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4224 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4225 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4226 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4227 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4228 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4229 represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
4230 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4231 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4232 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4233 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4234 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4235 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4236 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4237 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4238
4239 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4240 @cindex checkbox blocking
4241 @cindex property, ORDERED
4242 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4243 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4244 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4245
4246 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4247
4248 @table @kbd
4249 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4250 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4251 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4252 intermediate state.
4253 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4254 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4255 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4256 intermediate state.
4257 @itemize @minus
4258 @item
4259 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4260 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4261 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4262 @item
4263 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4264 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4265 @item
4266 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4267 @end itemize
4268 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4269 Insert a new item with a checkbox.
4270 This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
4271 (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4272 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4273 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4274 @cindex property, ORDERED
4275 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4276 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4277 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4278 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4279 for better visibility, customize the variable
4280 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4281 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4282 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4283 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4284 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4285 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4286 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4287 hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
4288 entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
4289 @end table
4290
4291 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4292 @chapter Tags
4293 @cindex tags
4294 @cindex headline tagging
4295 @cindex matching, tags
4296 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4297
4298 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4299 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
4300 support for tags.
4301
4302 @vindex org-tag-faces
4303 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4304 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4305 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4306 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4307 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4308 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4309 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4310 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4311
4312 @menu
4313 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4314 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4315 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4316 @end menu
4317
4318 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4319 @section Tag inheritance
4320 @cindex tag inheritance
4321 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4322 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4323
4324 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4325 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4326 well. For example, in the list
4327
4328 @example
4329 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4330 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4331 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4332 @end example
4333
4334 @noindent
4335 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4336 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4337 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4338 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4339 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4340 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4341 changes in the line.}:
4342
4343 @cindex #+FILETAGS
4344 @example
4345 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4346 @end example
4347
4348 @noindent
4349 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4350 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4351 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4352 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4353 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4354
4355 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4356 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4357 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4358 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4359 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4360 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4361 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4362 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4363
4364 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4365 @section Setting tags
4366 @cindex setting tags
4367 @cindex tags, setting
4368
4369 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4370 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4371 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4372 also a special command for inserting tags:
4373
4374 @table @kbd
4375 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4376 @cindex completion, of tags
4377 @vindex org-tags-column
4378 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer
4379 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4380 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4381 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4382 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4383 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4384 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4385 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4386 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4387 @end table
4388
4389 @vindex org-tag-alist
4390 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4391 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4392 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4393 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4394 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4395
4396 @cindex #+TAGS
4397 @example
4398 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4399 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4400 @end example
4401
4402 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4403 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4404 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4405
4406 @example
4407 #+TAGS:
4408 @end example
4409
4410 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4411 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4412 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4413 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4414 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4415 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4416
4417 @example
4418 #+STARTUP: noptag
4419 @end example
4420
4421 By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4422 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4423 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4424 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4425 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4426 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4427 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4428 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4429 like:
4430
4431 @lisp
4432 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4433 @end lisp
4434
4435 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4436 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4437
4438 @example
4439 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4440 @end example
4441
4442 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4443 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4444 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4445
4446 @example
4447 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4448 @end example
4449
4450 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4451
4452 @example
4453 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4454 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4455 @end example
4456
4457 @noindent
4458 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4459 braces, as in:
4460
4461 @example
4462 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4463 @end example
4464
4465 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4466 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4467
4468 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4469 these lines to activate any changes.
4470
4471 @noindent
4472 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4473 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4474 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4475 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4476 configuration:
4477
4478 @lisp
4479 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4480 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4481 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4482 (:endgroup . nil)
4483 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4484 @end lisp
4485
4486 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4487 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4488 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4489 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4490 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4491 keys:
4492
4493 @table @kbd
4494 @item a-z...
4495 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4496 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4497 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4498 @kindex @key{TAB}
4499 @item @key{TAB}
4500 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4501 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4502 @kindex @key{SPC}
4503 @item @key{SPC}
4504 Clear all tags for this line.
4505 @kindex @key{RET}
4506 @item @key{RET}
4507 Accept the modified set.
4508 @item C-g
4509 Abort without installing changes.
4510 @item q
4511 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4512 @item !
4513 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4514 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4515 @item C-c
4516 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4517 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4518 selection window.
4519 @end table
4520
4521 @noindent
4522 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4523 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4524 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4525 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4526 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4527 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4528 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4529 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4530
4531 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4532 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4533 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4534 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4535 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4536 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4537 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4538 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4539 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4540 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4541 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4542
4543 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4544 @section Tag searches
4545 @cindex tag searches
4546 @cindex searching for tags
4547
4548 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4549 information into special lists.
4550
4551 @table @kbd
4552 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
4553 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4554 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4555 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4556 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4557 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4558 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4559 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4560 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4561 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4562 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4563 @end table
4564
4565 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4566 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4567 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4568 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4569 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4570 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4571 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4572
4573
4574 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4575 @chapter Properties and columns
4576 @cindex properties
4577
4578 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
4579 are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
4580 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
4581 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
4582 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
4583 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4584 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
4585 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4586 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
4587 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
4588 where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
4589 release, number of tracks, and so on.
4590
4591 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4592 (@pxref{Column view}).
4593
4594 @menu
4595 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4596 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
4597 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4598 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4599 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4600 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4601 @end menu
4602
4603 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4604 @section Property syntax
4605 @cindex property syntax
4606 @cindex drawer, for properties
4607
4608 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
4609 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4610 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4611 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4612
4613 @example
4614 * CD collection
4615 ** Classic
4616 *** Goldberg Variations
4617 :PROPERTIES:
4618 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4619 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4620 :Artist: Glen Gould
4621 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4622 :NDisks: 1
4623 :END:
4624 @end example
4625
4626 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4627 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4628 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4629 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4630 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4631 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4632 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4633
4634 @example
4635 * CD collection
4636 :PROPERTIES:
4637 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4638 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4639 :END:
4640 @end example
4641
4642 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4643 file, use a line like
4644 @cindex property, _ALL
4645 @cindex #+PROPERTY
4646 @example
4647 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4648 @end example
4649
4650 @vindex org-global-properties
4651 Property values set with the global variable
4652 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4653 Org files.
4654
4655 @noindent
4656 The following commands help to work with properties:
4657
4658 @table @kbd
4659 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},org-complete}
4660 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4661 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4662 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4663 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4664 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4665 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4666 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
4667 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4668 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4669 information like deadlines.
4670 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4671 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4672 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4673 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4674 can be inserted using completion.
4675 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4676 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4677 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4678 Remove a property from the current entry.
4679 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4680 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4681 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4682 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4683 nearest column format definition.
4684 @end table
4685
4686 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4687 @section Special properties
4688 @cindex properties, special
4689
4690 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode
4691 features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the
4692 previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
4693 these states in a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
4694 queries. The following property names are special and should not be
4695 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4696
4697 @cindex property, special, TODO
4698 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4699 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4700 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4701 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4702 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4703 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4704 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4705 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4706 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4707 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4708 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4709 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4710 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4711 @example
4712 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4713 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4714 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4715 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4716 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4717 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4718 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4719 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4720 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4721 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4722 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4723 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
4724 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4725 ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4726 @end example
4727
4728 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4729 @section Property searches
4730 @cindex properties, searching
4731 @cindex searching, of properties
4732
4733 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4734 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4735 @table @kbd
4736 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
4737 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4738 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4739 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4740 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4741 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4742 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4743 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4744 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4745 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4746 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4747 @end table
4748
4749 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4750 properties}.
4751
4752 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4753 single property:
4754
4755 @table @kbd
4756 @orgkey{C-c / p}
4757 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4758 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4759 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4760 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
4761 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4762 @end table
4763
4764 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4765 @section Property Inheritance
4766 @cindex properties, inheritance
4767 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4768
4769 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4770 The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself to an
4771 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
4772 property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
4773 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4774 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4775 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4776 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
4777 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4778 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4779 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
4780 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
4781 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
4782
4783 Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4784 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4785
4786 @cindex property, COLUMNS
4787 @table @code
4788 @item COLUMNS
4789 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4790 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4791 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4792 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4793 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4794 @item CATEGORY
4795 @cindex property, CATEGORY
4796 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4797 applies to the entire subtree.
4798 @item ARCHIVE
4799 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
4800 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4801 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
4802 @item LOGGING
4803 @cindex property, LOGGING
4804 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4805 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4806 @end table
4807
4808 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4809 @section Column view
4810
4811 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4812 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
4813 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4814 entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4815 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4816 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4817 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4818 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4819 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4820 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4821 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4822 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4823 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4824
4825 @menu
4826 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4827 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4828 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4829 @end menu
4830
4831 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4832 @subsection Defining columns
4833 @cindex column view, for properties
4834 @cindex properties, column view
4835
4836 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4837 done by defining a column format line.
4838
4839 @menu
4840 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4841 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4842 @end menu
4843
4844 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4845 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4846
4847 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4848
4849 @cindex #+COLUMNS
4850 @example
4851 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4852 @end example
4853
4854 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4855 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4856
4857 @example
4858 ** Top node for columns view
4859 :PROPERTIES:
4860 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4861 :END:
4862 @end example
4863
4864 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4865 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4866 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4867 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4868 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4869 deeper part of the tree.
4870
4871 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4872 @subsubsection Column attributes
4873 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4874 definition looks like this:
4875
4876 @example
4877 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
4878 @end example
4879
4880 @noindent
4881 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4882 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4883
4884 @example
4885 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
4886 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
4887 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
4888 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
4889 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
4890 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
4891 @r{name is used.}
4892 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
4893 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4894 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4895 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4896 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4897 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4898 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
4899 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
4900 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
4901 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
4902 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
4903 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
4904 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
4905 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
4906 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
4907 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
4908 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4909 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4910 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4911 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
4912 @end example
4913
4914 @noindent
4915 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
4916 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
4917 same summary information.
4918
4919 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
4920 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
4921 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
4922 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
4923 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
4924 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
4925
4926 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
4927 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
4928 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
4929 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
4930 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
4931 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
4932 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
4933 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
4934
4935 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4936 values.
4937
4938 @example
4939 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
4940 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4941 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4942 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4943 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4944 @end example
4945
4946 @noindent
4947 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
4948 item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
4949 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4950 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4951 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4952 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4953 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4954 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4955 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
4956 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4957 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
4958 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4959 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4960 in the subtree.
4961
4962 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4963 @subsection Using column view
4964
4965 @table @kbd
4966 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4967 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
4968 @vindex org-columns-default-format
4969 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
4970 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
4971 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
4972 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
4973 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
4974 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
4975 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
4976 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
4977 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
4978 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
4979 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
4980 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
4981 Same as @kbd{r}.
4982 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
4983 Exit column view.
4984 @tsubheading{Editing values}
4985 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
4986 Move through the column view from field to field.
4987 @kindex S-@key{left}
4988 @kindex S-@key{right}
4989 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4990 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
4991 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
4992 @item 1..9,0
4993 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
4994 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
4995 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
4996 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
4997 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
4998 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
4999 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5000 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5001 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5002 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5003 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5004 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5005 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5006 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5007 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5008 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5009 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5010 current column view.
5011 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5012 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5013 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5014 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5015 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5016 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5017 Delete the current column.
5018 @end table
5019
5020 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5021 @subsection Capturing column view
5022
5023 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5024 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5025 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5026 of this block looks like this:
5027
5028 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5029 @example
5030 * The column view
5031 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5032
5033 #+END:
5034 @end example
5035
5036 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5037
5038 @table @code
5039 @item :id
5040 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5041 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5042 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5043 capture, you can use 4 values:
5044 @cindex property, ID
5045 @example
5046 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5047 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5048 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5049 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5050 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5051 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5052 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5053 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5054 @end example
5055 @item :hlines
5056 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5057 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5058 @item :vlines
5059 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5060 @item :maxlevel
5061 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5062 @item :skip-empty-rows
5063 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5064 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5065
5066 @end table
5067
5068 @noindent
5069 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5070
5071 @table @kbd
5072 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5073 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5074 for the scope or ID of the view.
5075 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5076 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5077 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5078 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5079 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5080 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5081 blocks in a buffer.
5082 @end table
5083
5084 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5085 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5086 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5087 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5088
5089 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5090 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5091 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5092 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5093 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5094 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5095 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5096
5097 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5098 @section The Property API
5099 @cindex properties, API
5100 @cindex API, for properties
5101
5102 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5103 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5104 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5105 property API}.
5106
5107 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5108 @chapter Dates and times
5109 @cindex dates
5110 @cindex times
5111 @cindex timestamp
5112 @cindex date stamp
5113
5114 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5115 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5116 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org-mode. This may be a
5117 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5118 something was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term
5119 is used in a much wider sense.
5120
5121 @menu
5122 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5123 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5124 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5125 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5126 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5127 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5128 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5129 @end menu
5130
5131
5132 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5133 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5134 @cindex timestamps
5135 @cindex ranges, time
5136 @cindex date stamps
5137 @cindex deadlines
5138 @cindex scheduling
5139
5140 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5141 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
5142 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
5143 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time
5144 format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
5145 timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
5146 Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
5147 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5148
5149 @table @var
5150 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5151 @cindex timestamp
5152 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5153 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5154 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5155 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5156
5157 @example
5158 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5159 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5160 @end example
5161
5162 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5163 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5164 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5165 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5166 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5167 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5168
5169 @example
5170 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5171 @end example
5172
5173 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5174 For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the
5175 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5176 package. For example
5177
5178 @example
5179 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5180 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5181 @end example
5182
5183 @item Time/Date range
5184 @cindex timerange
5185 @cindex date range
5186 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5187 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5188 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5189
5190 @example
5191 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5192 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5193 @end example
5194
5195 @item Inactive timestamp
5196 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5197 @cindex inactive timestamp
5198 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5199 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5200 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5201
5202 @example
5203 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
5204 @end example
5205
5206 @end table
5207
5208 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5209 @section Creating timestamps
5210 @cindex creating timestamps
5211 @cindex timestamps, creating
5212
5213 For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5214 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5215 format.
5216
5217 @table @kbd
5218 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5219 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5220 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5221 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5222 succession, a time range is inserted.
5223 @c
5224 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5225 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5226 an agenda entry.
5227 @c
5228 @kindex C-u C-c .
5229 @kindex C-u C-c !
5230 @item C-u C-c .
5231 @itemx C-u C-c !
5232 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5233 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5234 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5235 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5236 @c
5237 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5238 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5239 @c
5240 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5241 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5242 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5243 instead.
5244 @c
5245 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5246 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5247 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5248 @c
5249 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5250 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5251 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5252 @c
5253 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5254 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5255 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5256 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5257 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5258 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5259 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5260 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5261 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5262 @c
5263 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5264 @cindex evaluate time range
5265 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5266 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5267 the following column).
5268 @end table
5269
5270
5271 @menu
5272 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
5273 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5274 @end menu
5275
5276 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5277 @subsection The date/time prompt
5278 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5279 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5280
5281 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5282 When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5283 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5284 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5285 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5286 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5287 copied from an email message. Org-mode will find whatever information is in
5288 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5289 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5290 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5291 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5292 information, Org-mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5293 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5294 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5295 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5296 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5297 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5298 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5299
5300 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5301 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
5302 in @b{bold}.
5303
5304 @example
5305 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
5306 2/5/3 --> 2003-02-05
5307 14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5308 12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5309 2/5 --> @b{2007}-02-05
5310 Fri --> nearest Friday (default date or later)
5311 sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
5312 feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
5313 sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
5314 12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5315 22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5316 w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5317 2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5318 2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
5319 @end example
5320
5321 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5322 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5323 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5324 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5325 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5326 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5327 the Nth such day. E.g.
5328
5329 @example
5330 +0 --> today
5331 . --> today
5332 +4d --> four days from today
5333 +4 --> same as above
5334 +2w --> two weeks from today
5335 ++5 --> five days from default date
5336 +2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
5337 @end example
5338
5339 @vindex parse-time-months
5340 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5341 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5342 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5343 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5344
5345 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5346 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use `-' or `-@{@}-' as the separator
5347 in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter case. E.g.
5348
5349 @example
5350 11am-1:15pm --> 11:00-13:15
5351 11am--1:15pm --> same as above
5352 11am+2:15 --> same as above
5353 @end example
5354
5355 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5356 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5357 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5358 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5359 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5360 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5361 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5362 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5363 from the minibuffer:
5364
5365 @kindex <
5366 @kindex >
5367 @kindex M-v
5368 @kindex C-v
5369 @kindex mouse-1
5370 @kindex S-@key{right}
5371 @kindex S-@key{left}
5372 @kindex S-@key{down}
5373 @kindex S-@key{up}
5374 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5375 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5376 @kindex @key{RET}
5377 @example
5378 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5379 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5380 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5381 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5382 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5383 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5384 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5385 @end example
5386
5387 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5388 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5389 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5390 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5391 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5392 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5393 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5394
5395 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5396 @subsection Custom time format
5397 @cindex custom date/time format
5398 @cindex time format, custom
5399 @cindex date format, custom
5400
5401 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5402 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5403 Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5404 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5405 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5406 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5407 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5408
5409 @table @kbd
5410 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5411 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5412 @end table
5413
5414 @noindent
5415 Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5416 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5417 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5418 following consequences:
5419 @itemize @bullet
5420 @item
5421 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5422 after.
5423 @item
5424 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5425 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5426 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5427 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5428 time will be changed by one minute.
5429 @item
5430 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5431 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5432 @item
5433 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5434 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5435 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5436 @item
5437 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5438 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5439 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5440 @end itemize
5441
5442
5443 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5444 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5445
5446 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5447
5448 @table @var
5449 @item DEADLINE
5450 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5451
5452 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5453 to be finished on that date.
5454
5455 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5456 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5457 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5458 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5459 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5460 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5461
5462 @example
5463 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5464 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5465 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5466 @end example
5467
5468 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5469 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5470 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5471
5472 @item SCHEDULED
5473 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5474
5475 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5476 date.
5477
5478 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5479 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5480 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5481 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5482 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5483 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.
5484 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5485
5486 @example
5487 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5488 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5489 @end example
5490
5491 @noindent
5492 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org-mode should @i{not} be
5493 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5494 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5495 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5496 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5497 Org users. In Org-mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5498 want to start working on an action item.
5499 @end table
5500
5501 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5502 entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5503 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5504 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5505 @c
5506 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5507 @c
5508 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode does not
5509 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5510 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5511 sexp entry matches.
5512
5513 @menu
5514 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5515 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5516 @end menu
5517
5518 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5519 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5520
5521 The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
5522 an item:
5523
5524 @table @kbd
5525 @c
5526 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5527 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5528 in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
5529 an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
5530 variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5531 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5532 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5533 deadline.
5534 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
5535 @c
5536 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5537 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5538 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5539 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5540 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5541 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5542 keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
5543 @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5544 scheduling time.
5545 @c
5546 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5547 @kindex k a
5548 @kindex k s
5549 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5550 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5551 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5552 schedule the marked item.
5553 @c
5554 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5555 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5556 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5557 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5558 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5559 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5560 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5561 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5562 @c
5563 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5564 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5565 @c
5566 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5567 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5568 @end table
5569
5570 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5571 @subsection Repeated tasks
5572 @cindex tasks, repeated
5573 @cindex repeated tasks
5574
5575 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
5576 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5577 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5578 @example
5579 ** TODO Pay the rent
5580 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5581 @end example
5582 @noindent
5583 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5584 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5585 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5586 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5587 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5588
5589 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5590 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5591 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5592 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5593 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5594 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5595 repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode deals with this in the following
5596 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5597 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5598 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5599 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5600 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5601 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5602 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5603 switch the date like this:
5604
5605 @example
5606 ** TODO Pay the rent
5607 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5608 @end example
5609
5610 @vindex org-log-repeat
5611 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5612 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5613 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5614 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5615 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5616
5617 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5618 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5619 will be visible.
5620
5621 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5622 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5623 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5624 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5625 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5626 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5627 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5628 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has
5629 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5630
5631 @example
5632 ** TODO Call Father
5633 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5634 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5635 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5636 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5637 and marked it done on Saturday.
5638 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5639 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5640 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5641 today.
5642 @end example
5643
5644 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5645 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5646
5647 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5648 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5649 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5650
5651
5652 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5653 @section Clocking work time
5654 @cindex clocking time
5655 @cindex time clocking
5656
5657 Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5658 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5659 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5660 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
5661 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5662 remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5663 between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
5664
5665 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5666 @lisp
5667 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5668 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5669 @end lisp
5670 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5671 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5672 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5673 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5674 what to do with it.
5675
5676 @menu
5677 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
5678 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
5679 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
5680 @end menu
5681
5682 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
5683 @subsection Clocking commands
5684
5685 @table @kbd
5686 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
5687 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5688 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5689 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5690 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5691 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5692 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5693 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5694 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5695 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5696 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5697 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5698 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5699 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5700 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5701 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5702 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5703 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5704 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5705 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5706 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5707 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5708 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5709 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5710 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5711 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5712 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5713 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5714 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5715 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5716 @c
5717 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
5718 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5719 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5720 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5721 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5722 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5723 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5724 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5725 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5726 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
5727 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
5728 @kindex C-c C-y
5729 @kindex C-c C-c
5730 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5731 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5732 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
5733 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5734 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
5735 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5736 if it is running in this same item.
5737 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-cancel}
5738 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5739 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
5740 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
5741 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
5742 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
5743 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
5744 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
5745 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
5746 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
5747 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
5748 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
5749 when you change the buffer (see variable
5750 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5751 @end table
5752
5753 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
5754 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
5755 worked on or closed during a day.
5756
5757 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
5758 @subsection The clock table
5759 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
5760 @cindex report, of clocked time
5761
5762 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
5763 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
5764 formatted as one or several Org tables.
5765
5766 @table @kbd
5767 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
5768 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
5769 report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
5770 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5771 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5772 update it.
5773 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5774 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5775 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5776 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
5777 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5778 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5779 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
5780 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5781 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5782 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
5783 @end table
5784
5785
5786 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
5787 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
5788
5789 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
5790 @example
5791 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
5792 #+END: clocktable
5793 @end example
5794 @noindent
5795 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
5796 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
5797 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
5798 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
5799
5800 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
5801 be selected:
5802 @example
5803 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
5804 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
5805 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5806 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5807 file @r{the full current buffer}
5808 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
5809 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
5810 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5811 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5812 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
5813 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5814 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5815 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5816 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5817 @r{these formats:}
5818 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5819 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5820 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5821 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
5822 2007 @r{the year 2007}
5823 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
5824 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
5825 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
5826 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
5827 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
5828 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
5829 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
5830 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5831 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
5832 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
5833 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
5834 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute}.
5835 @end example
5836
5837 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
5838 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
5839 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
5840 @example
5841 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
5842 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
5843 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
5844 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
5845 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
5846 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
5847 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
5848 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
5849 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
5850 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
5851 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
5852 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
5853 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
5854 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
5855 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
5856 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
5857 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
5858 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
5859 @end example
5860 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
5861 day, you could write
5862 @example
5863 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
5864 #+END: clocktable
5865 @end example
5866 @noindent
5867 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
5868 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
5869 only to fit it into the manual.}
5870 @example
5871 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
5872 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
5873 #+END: clocktable
5874 @end example
5875 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
5876 @example
5877 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
5878 #+END: clocktable
5879 @end example
5880 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
5881 would be
5882 @example
5883 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
5884 #+END: clocktable
5885 @end example
5886
5887 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
5888 @subsection Resolving idle time
5889 @cindex resolve idle time
5890
5891 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
5892 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
5893 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
5894 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
5895 applying it to another one.
5896
5897 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
5898 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
5899 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
5900 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
5901 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
5902 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
5903 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
5904 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
5905 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
5906 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
5907 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
5908 choices to correct the discrepancy:
5909
5910 @table @kbd
5911 @item k
5912 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
5913 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
5914 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
5915 @item K
5916 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
5917 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
5918 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
5919 @item s
5920 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
5921 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
5922 @item S
5923 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
5924 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
5925 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
5926 @item C
5927 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
5928 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
5929 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
5930 log with an empty entry.
5931 @end table
5932
5933 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
5934 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
5935 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
5936 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
5937 the next task you clock in on.
5938
5939 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
5940 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
5941 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
5942 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
5943 mode changes, including your last clock in.
5944
5945 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
5946 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
5947 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
5948 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
5949 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it's just happening due
5950 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
5951
5952 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
5953 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
5954
5955 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
5956 @section Effort estimates
5957 @cindex effort estimates
5958
5959 @cindex property, Effort
5960 @vindex org-effort-property
5961 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
5962 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
5963 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
5964 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
5965 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
5966 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
5967 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
5968 for an entry with the following commands:
5969
5970 @table @kbd
5971 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
5972 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
5973 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
5974 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
5975 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
5976 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
5977 @end table
5978
5979 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
5980 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
5981 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
5982 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
5983 buffer you can use
5984
5985 @example
5986 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
5987 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5988 @end example
5989
5990 @noindent
5991 @vindex org-global-properties
5992 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5993 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
5994 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
5995 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
5996 setup may be advised.
5997
5998 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
5999 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6000 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6001 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6002
6003 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6004 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6005 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6006 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6007 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6008 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6009 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6010 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6011 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6012
6013 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6014 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6015 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6016 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6017
6018 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6019 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6020 @cindex relative timer
6021
6022 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6023 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6024 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6025
6026 @table @kbd
6027 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6028 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6029 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6030 restarted.
6031 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6032 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6033 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6034 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6035 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6036 new timer items.
6037 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6038 @kindex C-c C-x ,
6039 @item C-c C-x ,
6040 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6041 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6042 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6043 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6044 @item C-u C-c C-x ,
6045 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6046 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6047 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6048 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6049 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6050 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6051 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6052 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6053 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6054 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6055 not started at exactly the right moment.
6056 @end table
6057
6058 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6059 @section Countdown timer
6060 @cindex Countdown timer
6061 @kindex C-c C-x ;
6062 @kindex ;
6063
6064 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org-mode buffer runs a countdown
6065 timer. Use @key{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everwhere else.
6066
6067 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6068 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6069 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6070 default value.
6071
6072 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6073 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6074 @cindex capture
6075
6076 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6077 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6078 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6079 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6080 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6081 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6082
6083 @menu
6084 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6085 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6086 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6087 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6088 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6089 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6090 @end menu
6091
6092 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6093 @section Capture
6094 @cindex capture
6095
6096 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6097 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6098 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org-mode for
6099 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6100 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6101
6102 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6103 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6104 @example
6105 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6106 @end example
6107 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6108 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6109 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6110 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6111
6112 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6113 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6114 does enhance it with templates and more.
6115
6116 @menu
6117 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6118 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6119 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6120 @end menu
6121
6122 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6123 @subsection Setting up capture
6124
6125 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6126 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6127 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6128
6129 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6130 @example
6131 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6132 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6133 @end example
6134
6135 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6136 @subsection Using capture
6137
6138 @table @kbd
6139 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6140 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6141 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6142 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6143 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6144 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6145 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6146
6147 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6148 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6149 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6150 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6151 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6152
6153 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6154 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6155 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6156 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6157 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6158 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6159 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6160
6161 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6162 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6163
6164 @end table
6165
6166 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6167 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6168 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6169 rather than to the current date.
6170
6171 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6172 prefix commands:
6173
6174 @table @kbd
6175 @orgkey{C-u C-c c}
6176 Visit the target location of a cpature template. You get to select the
6177 template in the usual way.
6178 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6179 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6180 @end table
6181
6182 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6183 @subsection Capture templates
6184 @cindex templates, for Capture
6185
6186 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6187 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6188 through the customize interface.
6189
6190 @table @kbd
6191 @orgkey{C-c c C}
6192 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6193 @end table
6194
6195 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6196 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6197 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6198 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6199 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6200 would look like:
6201
6202 @example
6203 (setq org-capture-templates
6204 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6205 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6206 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6207 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6208 @end example
6209
6210 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6211 for you like this:
6212 @example
6213 * TODO
6214 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6215 @end example
6216
6217 @noindent
6218 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6219 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6220 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6221 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6222 place where you started the capture process.
6223
6224
6225 @menu
6226 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6227 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6228 @end menu
6229
6230 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6231 @subsubsection Template elements
6232
6233 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6234 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6235
6236 @table @var
6237 @item keys
6238 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6239 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6240 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6241 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6242 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6243 prefix key, for example
6244 @example
6245 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6246 @end example
6247 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6248 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6249
6250 @item description
6251 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6252 selection.
6253
6254 @item type
6255 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6256 @table @code
6257 @item entry
6258 An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the
6259 target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org-mode
6260 file.
6261 @item item
6262 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6263 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6264 @item checkitem
6265 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6266 default template.
6267 @item table-line
6268 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6269 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6270 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6271 @item plain
6272 Text to be inserted as it is.
6273 @end table
6274
6275 @item target
6276 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6277 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org-mode
6278 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6279 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6280 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6281 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}.
6282
6283 Valid values are:
6284 @table @code
6285 @item (file "path/to/file")
6286 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6287
6288 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6289 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6290
6291 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6292 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6293
6294 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6295 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6296
6297 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6298 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6299
6300 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6301 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6302
6303 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6304 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6305
6306 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6307 A function to find the right location in the file.
6308
6309 @item (clock)
6310 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6311
6312 @item (function function-finding-location)
6313 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6314 file and location.
6315 @end table
6316
6317 @item template
6318 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6319 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6320 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6321 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6322 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6323 more details.
6324
6325 @item properties
6326 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6327 Recognized properties are:
6328 @table @code
6329 @item :prepend
6330 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6331 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6332 Setting this property will change that.
6333
6334 @item :immediate-finish
6335 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6336 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6337 information that can be added automatically.
6338
6339 @item :empty-lines
6340 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6341 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6342
6343 @item :clock-in
6344 Start the clock in this item.
6345
6346 @item :clock-resume
6347 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6348 with the capture.
6349
6350 @item :unnarrowed
6351 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6352 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6353
6354 @item :kill-buffer
6355 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6356 buffer again after capture is completed.
6357 @end table
6358 @end table
6359
6360 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6361 @subsubsection Template expansion
6362
6363 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6364 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6365 dynamic insertion of content:
6366
6367 @comment SJE: should these sentences terminate in period?
6368 @smallexample
6369 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6370 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6371 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
6372 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6373 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
6374 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
6375 %i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6376 @r{region is active.}
6377 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6378 %t @r{timestamp, date only}
6379 %T @r{timestamp with date and time}
6380 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
6381 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
6382 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
6383 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
6384 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6385 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6386 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6387 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6388 %k @r{title of the currently clocked task}
6389 %K @r{link to the currently clocked task}
6390 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6391 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6392 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
6393 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
6394 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
6395 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
6396 @end smallexample
6397
6398 @noindent
6399 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6400 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6401 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6402 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6403 similar way.}:
6404
6405 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6406 @smallexample
6407 Link type | Available keywords
6408 -------------------+----------------------------------------------
6409 bbdb | %:name %:company
6410 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6411 vm, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6412 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6413 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6414 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6415 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6416 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6417 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6418 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6419 w3, w3m | %:url
6420 info | %:file %:node
6421 calendar | %:date
6422 @end smallexample
6423
6424 @noindent
6425 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6426
6427 @smallexample
6428 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6429 @end smallexample
6430
6431
6432 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6433 @section Attachments
6434 @cindex attachments
6435
6436 @vindex org-attach-directory
6437 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6438 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6439 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6440 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6441 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6442 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6443 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6444 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6445 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6446 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6447 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6448 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6449 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6450
6451 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6452 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6453 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6454 directory.
6455
6456 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6457
6458 @table @kbd
6459
6460 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6461 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6462 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6463 to select a command:
6464
6465 @table @kbd
6466 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6467 @vindex org-attach-method
6468 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6469 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6470 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6471
6472 @kindex C-c C-a c
6473 @kindex C-c C-a m
6474 @kindex C-c C-a l
6475 @item c/m/l
6476 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6477 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6478
6479 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6480 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6481
6482 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6483 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6484 attachments yourself.
6485
6486 @orgcmdtkc{p,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6487 @vindex org-file-apps
6488 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6489 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6490 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6491 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6492
6493 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6494 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6495
6496 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6497 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6498
6499 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6500 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6501
6502 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6503 Select and delete a single attachment.
6504
6505 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6506 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6507 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6508
6509 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6510 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6511 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6512 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6513
6514 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6515 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6516 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6517 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6518 @end table
6519 @end table
6520
6521 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6522 @section RSS feeds
6523 @cindex RSS feeds
6524 @cindex Atom feeds
6525
6526 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6527 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6528 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6529 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6530 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6531 information. Here is just an example:
6532
6533 @example
6534 (setq org-feed-alist
6535 '(("Slashdot"
6536 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6537 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6538 @end example
6539
6540 @noindent
6541 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6542 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6543 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6544 the following command is used:
6545
6546 @table @kbd
6547 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6548 @item C-c C-x g
6549 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6550 them.
6551 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6552 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6553 @end table
6554
6555 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6556 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6557 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6558 list of drawers in that file:
6559
6560 @example
6561 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6562 @end example
6563
6564 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6565 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6566
6567 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6568 @section Protocols for external access
6569 @cindex protocols, for external access
6570 @cindex emacsserver
6571
6572 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6573 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6574 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6575 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6576 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6577 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6578 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6579 documentation and setup instructions.
6580
6581 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6582 @section Refiling notes
6583 @cindex refiling notes
6584
6585 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6586 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6587 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6588 process, you can use the following special command:
6589
6590 @table @kbd
6591 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
6592 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6593 @vindex org-refile-targets
6594 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6595 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6596 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6597 @vindex org-log-refile
6598 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6599 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6600 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6601 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6602 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6603 last subitem.@*
6604 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6605 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6606 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6607 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6608 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6609 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6610 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6611 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6612 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6613 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6614 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a time stamp or a note will be
6615 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6616 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
6617 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6618 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
6619 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6620 @item C-2 C-c C-w
6621 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6622 @item C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
6623
6624 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
6625
6626 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6627 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
6628 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6629 @end table
6630
6631 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6632 @section Archiving
6633 @cindex archiving
6634
6635 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6636 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6637 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6638 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6639
6640 @table @kbd
6641 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
6642 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6643 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6644 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6645 @end table
6646
6647 @menu
6648 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6649 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
6650 @end menu
6651
6652 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6653 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6654 @cindex external archiving
6655
6656 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6657 the archive file.
6658
6659 @table @kbd
6660 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
6661 @vindex org-archive-location
6662 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6663 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6664 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
6665 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6666 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6667 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6668 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6669 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6670 @end table
6671
6672 @cindex archive locations
6673 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6674 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6675 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6676 see the documentation string of the variable
6677 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6678 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6679 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6680 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6681 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6682 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6683 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6684 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6685
6686 @cindex #+ARCHIVE
6687 @example
6688 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6689 @end example
6690
6691 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6692 @noindent
6693 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6694 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6695 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6696
6697 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6698 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6699 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6700 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6701 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6702 added.
6703
6704
6705 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6706 @subsection Internal archiving
6707
6708 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6709 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6710
6711 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6712 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6713 @itemize @minus
6714 @item
6715 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6716 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6717 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6718 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6719 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6720 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6721 @item
6722 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6723 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6724 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
6725 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
6726 @item
6727 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
6728 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
6729 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
6730 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
6731 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
6732 temporarily included.
6733 @item
6734 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
6735 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
6736 is. Configure the details using the variable
6737 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
6738 @item
6739 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
6740 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
6741 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
6742 @end itemize
6743
6744 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
6745
6746 @table @kbd
6747 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
6748 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
6749 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
6750 hidden.
6751 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
6752 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
6753 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
6754 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
6755 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
6756 level 1 trees will be checked.
6757 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
6758 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
6759 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
6760 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
6761 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
6762 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
6763 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
6764 outline.
6765 @end table
6766
6767
6768 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
6769 @chapter Agenda views
6770 @cindex agenda views
6771
6772 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
6773 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
6774 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
6775 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
6776 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
6777
6778 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
6779 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
6780
6781 @itemize @bullet
6782 @item
6783 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
6784 for specific dates,
6785 @item
6786 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
6787 action items,
6788 @item
6789 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
6790 TODO state associated with them,
6791 @item
6792 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
6793 in time-sorted view,
6794 @item
6795 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
6796 that contain specified keywords,
6797 @item
6798 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
6799 along, and
6800 @item
6801 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
6802 views.
6803 @end itemize
6804
6805 @noindent
6806 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
6807 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
6808 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
6809 edit these files remotely.
6810
6811 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
6812 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
6813 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
6814 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
6815 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
6816 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
6817
6818 @menu
6819 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
6820 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
6821 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
6822 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
6823 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
6824 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
6825 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
6826 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
6827 @end menu
6828
6829 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
6830 @section Agenda files
6831 @cindex agenda files
6832 @cindex files for agenda
6833
6834 @vindex org-agenda-files
6835 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
6836 files}, the files listed in the variable
6837 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
6838 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
6839 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
6840 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
6841 of the list.
6842
6843 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
6844 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
6845 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
6846 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
6847 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
6848 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
6849
6850 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
6851 @table @kbd
6852 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-to-front}
6853 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
6854 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
6855 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
6856 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
6857 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
6858 @kindex C-,
6859 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
6860 @itemx C-,
6861 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
6862 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
6863 @item M-x org-iswitchb
6864 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
6865 buffers.
6866 @end table
6867
6868 @noindent
6869 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
6870 to visit any of them.
6871
6872 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
6873 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
6874 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
6875 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
6876 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
6877 extended period, use the following commands:
6878
6879 @table @kbd
6880 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
6881 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
6882 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
6883 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
6884 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
6885 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
6886 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
6887 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
6888 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
6889 @end table
6890
6891 @noindent
6892 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
6893 the Speedbar frame:
6894 @table @kbd
6895 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
6896 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
6897 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
6898 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
6899 effect immediately.
6900 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
6901 Lift the restriction.
6902 @end table
6903
6904 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
6905 @section The agenda dispatcher
6906 @cindex agenda dispatcher
6907 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
6908 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
6909 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
6910 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
6911 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
6912 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
6913 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
6914 @table @kbd
6915 @item a
6916 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
6917 @item t @r{/} T
6918 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
6919 @item m @r{/} M
6920 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
6921 tags and properties}).
6922 @item L
6923 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
6924 @item s
6925 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
6926 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
6927 @item /
6928 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
6929 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
6930 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
6931 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
6932 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
6933 1.
6934 @item # @r{/} !
6935 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
6936 @item <
6937 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
6938 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
6939 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
6940 selecting the command.
6941 @item < <
6942 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
6943 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
6944 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
6945 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
6946 character selecting the command.
6947 @end table
6948
6949 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
6950 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
6951 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
6952 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
6953 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
6954
6955 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
6956 @section The built-in agenda views
6957
6958 In this section we describe the built-in views.
6959
6960 @menu
6961 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
6962 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
6963 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
6964 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
6965 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
6966 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
6967 @end menu
6968
6969 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
6970 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
6971 @cindex agenda
6972 @cindex weekly agenda
6973 @cindex daily agenda
6974
6975 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
6976 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
6977
6978 @table @kbd
6979 @cindex org-agenda, command
6980 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
6981 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
6982 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
6983 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
6984 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
6985 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
6986 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
6987 @end table
6988
6989 @vindex org-agenda-span
6990 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
6991 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
6992 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
6993 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
6994 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
6995 @code{year}.
6996
6997 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
6998 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
6999 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7000 commands}.
7001
7002 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7003 @cindex calendar integration
7004 @cindex diary integration
7005
7006 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7007 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7008 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7009 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7010 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7011 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7012 the diary.
7013
7014 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
7015 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7016
7017 @lisp
7018 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7019 @end lisp
7020
7021 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7022 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7023 agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7024 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7025 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7026 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7027 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7028 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7029 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7030 between calendar and agenda.
7031
7032 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7033 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7034 the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7035 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7036 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7037 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7038 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7039 will be made in the agenda:
7040
7041 @example
7042 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7043 #+CATEGORY: Holiday
7044 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7045 #+CATEGORY: Ann
7046 %%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)@footnote{Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends on the setting of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7047 %%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7048 @end example
7049
7050 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7051 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7052 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7053
7054 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7055 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7056 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7057 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7058 following to one your your agenda files:
7059
7060 @example
7061 * Anniversaries
7062 :PROPERTIES:
7063 :CATEGORY: Anniv
7064 :END:
7065 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7066 @end example
7067
7068 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7069 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7070 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD}, followed by a
7071 space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or @samp{wedding}, or
7072 a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to @samp{birthday}.
7073 Here are a few examples, the header for the file @file{org-bbdb.el} contains
7074 more detailed information.
7075
7076 @example
7077 1973-06-22
7078 1955-08-02 wedding
7079 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
7080 @end example
7081
7082 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7083 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7084 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7085 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7086 in an Org or Diary file.
7087
7088 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7089 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7090 @cindex appointment reminders
7091
7092 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
7093 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
7094 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
7095 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
7096 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
7097
7098 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7099 @subsection The global TODO list
7100 @cindex global TODO list
7101 @cindex TODO list, global
7102
7103 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7104 collected into a single place.
7105
7106 @table @kbd
7107 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7108 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7109 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7110 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7111 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7112 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7113 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7114 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7115 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7116 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7117 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7118 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7119 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7120 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7121 @kindex r
7122 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7123 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7124 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7125 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7126 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7127 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7128 @end table
7129
7130 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7131 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7132 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7133
7134 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7135 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7136 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7137 it more compact:
7138 @itemize @minus
7139 @item
7140 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7141 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7142 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7143 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7144 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7145 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7146 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7147 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7148 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7149 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7150 TODO list.
7151 @item
7152 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7153 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7154 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7155 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7156 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7157 @end itemize
7158
7159 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7160 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7161 @cindex matching, of tags
7162 @cindex matching, of properties
7163 @cindex tags view
7164 @cindex match view
7165
7166 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7167 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7168 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7169 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7170 m}.
7171
7172 @table @kbd
7173 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7174 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7175 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7176 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7177 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7178 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7179 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7180 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7181 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7182 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7183 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7184 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7185 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7186 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7187 @ref{Tag searches}.
7188 @end table
7189
7190 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7191 commands}.
7192
7193 @subsubheading Match syntax
7194
7195 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7196 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7197 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7198 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7199 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7200 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7201 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7202 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7203 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7204
7205 @table @samp
7206 @item +work-boss
7207 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7208 @samp{:boss:}.
7209 @item work|laptop
7210 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7211 @item work|laptop+night
7212 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7213 @samp{:night:}.
7214 @end table
7215
7216 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7217 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7218 braces. For example,
7219 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7220 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7221
7222 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7223 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7224 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7225 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7226 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7227 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7228 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7229 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7230 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7231 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7232 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7233 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7234 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7235
7236 Here are more examples:
7237 @table @samp
7238 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7239 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7240 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7241 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7242 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7243 @end table
7244
7245 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7246 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7247
7248 @example
7249 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7250 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7251 @end example
7252
7253 @noindent
7254 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7255 @itemize @minus
7256 @item
7257 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7258 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7259 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7260 @item
7261 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7262 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7263 @item
7264 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7265 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7266 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7267 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7268 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7269 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
7270 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7271 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7272 respectively, can be used.
7273 @item
7274 If the comparison value is enclosed
7275 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7276 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7277 match.
7278 @end itemize
7279
7280 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7281 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7282 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7283 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7284 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7285 on or after October 11, 2008.
7286
7287 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7288 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7289 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7290 again.
7291
7292 You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7293 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7294 inheritance}, for details.
7295
7296 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7297 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7298 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7299 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7300 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7301 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7302 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7303 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7304 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7305 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7306 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7307 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7308
7309 @table @samp
7310 @item work/WAITING
7311 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7312 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7313 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7314 nor @samp{NEXT}
7315 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7316 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7317 @samp{NEXT}.
7318 @end table
7319
7320 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7321 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7322 @cindex timeline, single file
7323 @cindex time-sorted view
7324
7325 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
7326 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7327 to give an overview over events in a project.
7328
7329 @table @kbd
7330 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7331 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7332 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7333 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7334 @end table
7335
7336 @noindent
7337 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7338 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7339
7340 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7341 @subsection Search view
7342 @cindex search view
7343 @cindex text search
7344 @cindex searching, for text
7345
7346 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
7347 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7348
7349 @table @kbd
7350 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7351 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7352 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7353 @end table
7354 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7355 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7356 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7357 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7358 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7359 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7360 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7361 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7362 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7363 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7364 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7365
7366 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7367 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7368 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7369
7370 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7371 @subsection Stuck projects
7372
7373 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7374 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7375 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7376 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7377 Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7378 projects and define next actions for them.
7379
7380 @table @kbd
7381 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7382 List projects that are stuck.
7383 @kindex C-c a !
7384 @item C-c a !
7385 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7386 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7387 project is and how to find it.
7388 @end table
7389
7390 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7391 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7392 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7393 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7394
7395 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
7396 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7397 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7398 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7399 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7400 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7401 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7402 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7403 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7404 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7405 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7406 correct customization for this is
7407
7408 @lisp
7409 (setq org-stuck-projects
7410 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7411 "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
7412 @end lisp
7413
7414 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7415 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7416
7417 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7418 @section Presentation and sorting
7419 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7420
7421 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7422 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares
7423 the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
7424 starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
7425 (@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
7426 customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7427 The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7428 associated with the item.
7429
7430 @menu
7431 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7432 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7433 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7434 @end menu
7435
7436 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7437 @subsection Categories
7438
7439 @cindex category
7440 @cindex #+CATEGORY
7441 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7442 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7443 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7444 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7445 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7446 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7447 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7448 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7449 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7450 property.}:
7451
7452 @example
7453 #+CATEGORY: Thesis
7454 @end example
7455
7456 @noindent
7457 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7458 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7459 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7460 special category you want to apply as the value.
7461
7462 @noindent
7463 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7464 longer than 10 characters.
7465
7466 @noindent
7467 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7468 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7469
7470 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7471 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7472 @cindex time-of-day specification
7473
7474 Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7475 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7476 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7477 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7478 @c
7479 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7480
7481 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7482 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7483 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7484 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7485
7486 For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7487 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7488 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7489
7490 @example
7491 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7492 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7493 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7494 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7495 @end example
7496
7497 @cindex time grid
7498 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7499 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7500
7501 @example
7502 8:00...... ------------------
7503 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7504 10:00...... ------------------
7505 12:00...... ------------------
7506 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7507 14:00...... ------------------
7508 16:00...... ------------------
7509 18:00...... ------------------
7510 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7511 20:00...... ------------------
7512 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7513 @end example
7514
7515 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7516 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7517 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7518 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7519 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7520
7521 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7522 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7523 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7524 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7525 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7526 done depends on the type of view.
7527 @itemize @bullet
7528 @item
7529 @vindex org-agenda-files
7530 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7531 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7532 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7533 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7534 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7535 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7536 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7537 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7538 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7539 @item
7540 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7541 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7542 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7543 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7544 or scheduled date.
7545 @item
7546 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7547 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7548 @end itemize
7549
7550 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7551 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7552 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7553 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7554
7555 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7556 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7557 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7558
7559 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7560 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7561 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7562 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7563 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7564 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7565
7566 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7567 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7568
7569 @table @kbd
7570 @tsubheading{Motion}
7571 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7572 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
7573 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7574 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
7575 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7576 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7577 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
7578 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7579 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7580 outline, not only the heading.
7581 @c
7582 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
7583 Display original location and recenter that window.
7584 @c
7585 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
7586 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
7587 @c
7588 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
7589 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7590 @c
7591 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
7592 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7593 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7594 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7595 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7596 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7597 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7598 @c
7599 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
7600 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7601 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7602 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7603 previously used indirect buffer.
7604
7605 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
7606 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7607 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7608 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7609
7610 @tsubheading{Change display}
7611 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7612 @kindex o
7613 @item o
7614 Delete other windows.
7615 @c
7616 @c @kindex v d
7617 @c @kindex d
7618 @c @kindex v w
7619 @c @kindex w
7620 @c @kindex v m
7621 @c @kindex v y
7622 @c @item v d @ @r{or short} @ d
7623 @c @itemx v w @ @r{or short} @ w
7624 @c @itemx v m
7625 @c @itemx v y
7626 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-aganda-day-view}
7627 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-aganda-day-view}
7628 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
7629 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-month-year}
7630 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
7631 this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
7632 month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
7633 A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
7634 of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
7635 @kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
7636 setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
7637 argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
7638 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
7639 be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
7640 @c
7641 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
7642 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7643 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7644 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7645 @c
7646 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
7647 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7648 @c
7649 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
7650 Go to today.
7651 @c
7652 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
7653 Prompt for a date and go there.
7654 @c
7655 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
7656 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
7657 @c
7658 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
7659 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7660 @c
7661 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
7662 @kindex v L
7663 @vindex org-log-done
7664 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7665 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7666 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7667 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7668 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7669 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7670 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7671 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7672 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7673 @c
7674 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
7675 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7676 agenda and timeline views.
7677 @c
7678 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
7679 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
7680 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7681 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7682 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7683 press @kbd{v a} again.
7684 @c
7685 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
7686 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7687 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7688 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7689 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7690 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7691 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
7692 when toggling this mode (i.e. @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
7693 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
7694 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}.
7695 @c
7696 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
7697 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7698 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7699 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7700 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7701 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7702 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7703 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7704 @c
7705 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
7706 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7707 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7708 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7709 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7710 @c
7711 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-rodo}
7712 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
7713 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
7714 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
7715 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
7716 keyword.
7717 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-rodo}
7718 Same as @kbd{r}.
7719 @c
7720 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
7721 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
7722 IDs.
7723 @c
7724 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
7725 @vindex org-columns-default-format
7726 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
7727 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
7728 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
7729 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
7730 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
7731 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
7732
7733 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7734 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
7735 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
7736
7737 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
7738 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
7739 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
7740 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
7741 @cindex query editing, in agenda
7742
7743 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
7744 @vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
7745 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
7746 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
7747 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
7748 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
7749 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
7750 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
7751 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
7752 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
7753 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
7754
7755 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
7756 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
7757 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
7758 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
7759 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
7760 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
7761 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
7762 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
7763 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
7764 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
7765
7766 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
7767 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
7768 efforts globally, for example
7769 @lisp
7770 (setq org-global-properties
7771 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
7772 @end lisp
7773 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
7774 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
7775 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
7776 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
7777 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
7778 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
7779 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
7780 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
7781 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
7782 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
7783
7784 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
7785 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
7786 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
7787 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
7788 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
7789 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
7790 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
7791 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
7792 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
7793
7794 @lisp
7795 @group
7796 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
7797 (and (cond
7798 ((string= tag "Net")
7799 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
7800 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
7801 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
7802 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
7803 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
7804 (concat "-" tag)))
7805
7806 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
7807 @end group
7808 @end lisp
7809
7810 @orgcmd{\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
7811 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
7812 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
7813 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
7814 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
7815
7816 @c
7817 @kindex [
7818 @kindex ]
7819 @kindex @{
7820 @kindex @}
7821 @item [ ] @{ @}
7822 @table @i
7823 @item @r{in} search view
7824 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
7825 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
7826 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
7827 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
7828 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
7829 selected.
7830 @end table
7831
7832 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
7833 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
7834
7835 @item 0-9
7836 Digit argument.
7837 @c
7838 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
7839 @cindex remote editing, undo
7840 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
7841 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
7842 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
7843 @c
7844 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
7845 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
7846 original org file.
7847 @c
7848 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
7849 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
7850 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
7851 @c
7852 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
7853 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
7854 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
7855 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
7856 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
7857 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
7858 @c
7859 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
7860 Refile the entry at point.
7861 @c
7862 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
7863 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7864 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
7865 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
7866 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
7867 @c
7868 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
7869 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
7870 @c
7871 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7872 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
7873 sibling}.
7874 @c
7875 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
7876 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
7877 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
7878 different file.
7879 @c
7880 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
7881 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
7882 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
7883 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
7884 tags of a headline occasionally.
7885 @c
7886 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
7887 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
7888 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
7889 @c
7890 @kindex ,
7891 @item ,
7892 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
7893 Org-mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the
7894 priority cookie is removed from the entry.
7895 @c
7896 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
7897 Display weighted priority of current item.
7898 @c
7899 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
7900 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
7901 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
7902 key for this.
7903 @c
7904 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
7905 Decrease the priority of the current item.
7906 @c
7907 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
7908 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
7909 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
7910 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
7911 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
7912 @c
7913 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
7914 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
7915 @c
7916 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
7917 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
7918 @c
7919 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
7920 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
7921 @c
7922 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-action}
7923 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
7924 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
7925 additional key:
7926 @example
7927 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
7928 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
7929 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
7930 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
7931 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
7932 @end example
7933 @noindent
7934 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
7935 command.
7936 @c
7937 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
7938 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
7939 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
7940 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
7941 @kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
7942 command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
7943 a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
7944 is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
7945 in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
7946 @c
7947 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
7948 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
7949 into the past.
7950 @c
7951 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
7952 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
7953 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
7954 @c
7955 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
7956 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
7957 is stopped first.
7958 @c
7959 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
7960 Stop the previously started clock.
7961 @c
7962 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
7963 Cancel the currently running clock.
7964 @c
7965 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
7966 Jump to the running clock in another window.
7967
7968 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
7969 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
7970
7971 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
7972 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
7973 successive entries.
7974 @c
7975 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
7976 Unmark entry for bulk action.
7977 @c
7978 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
7979 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
7980 @c
7981 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
7982 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
7983 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
7984 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
7985 these special timestamps.
7986 @example
7987 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
7988 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
7989 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
7990 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
7991 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
7992 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
7993 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).}
7994 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
7995 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
7996 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
7997 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
7998 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
7999 S @r{Reschedule randomly by N days. N will be prompted for. With prefix}
8000 @r{arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only accross weekdays.}
8001 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8002 @end example
8003
8004
8005 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8006 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8007
8008 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8009 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8010 @c
8011 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8012 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
8013 date at the cursor.
8014 @c
8015 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8016 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8017 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8018 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8019 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8020 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8021 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8022 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8023 you can add the entry.
8024
8025 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
8026 Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8027 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8028 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8029 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8030 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8031 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8032 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8033 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8034 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8035 @c
8036 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8037 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8038 @c
8039 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8040 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8041 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8042 @c
8043 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8044 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8045 calendars.
8046 @c
8047 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8048 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8049
8050 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8051 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8052 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8053
8054 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8055 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8056 @cindex exporting agenda views
8057 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8058 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8059 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8060 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8061 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8062 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8063 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8064 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8065 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8066
8067 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8068 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8069 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8070 @c
8071 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8072 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8073 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8074 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8075 visit Org files will not be removed.
8076 @end table
8077
8078
8079 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8080 @section Custom agenda views
8081 @cindex custom agenda views
8082 @cindex agenda views, custom
8083
8084 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8085 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8086 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8087 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8088
8089 @menu
8090 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8091 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8092 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8093 @end menu
8094
8095 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8096 @subsection Storing searches
8097
8098 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8099 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8100 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8101 buffer).
8102 @kindex C-c a C
8103 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8104 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8105 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8106 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
8107 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
8108 search types:
8109
8110 @lisp
8111 @group
8112 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8113 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8114 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8115 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8116 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8117 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8118 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8119 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8120 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8121 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8122 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8123 @end group
8124 @end lisp
8125
8126 @noindent
8127 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8128 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8129 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8130 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8131 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8132 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8133 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8134 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8135 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8136 therefore define:
8137
8138 @table @kbd
8139 @item C-c a w
8140 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8141 keyword
8142 @item C-c a W
8143 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8144 results as a sparse tree
8145 @item C-c a u
8146 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8147 @samp{:urgent:}
8148 @item C-c a v
8149 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8150 headlines that are also TODO items
8151 @item C-c a U
8152 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8153 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8154 @item C-c a f
8155 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8156 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8157 @item C-c a h
8158 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8159 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8160 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8161 @end table
8162
8163 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8164 @subsection Block agenda
8165 @cindex block agenda
8166 @cindex agenda, with block views
8167
8168 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8169 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8170 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8171 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8172 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8173 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8174 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8175
8176 @lisp
8177 @group
8178 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8179 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8180 ((agenda "")
8181 (tags-todo "home")
8182 (tags "garden")))
8183 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8184 ((agenda "")
8185 (tags-todo "work")
8186 (tags "office")))))
8187 @end group
8188 @end lisp
8189
8190 @noindent
8191 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8192 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8193 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8194 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8195 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8196
8197 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8198 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8199 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8200
8201 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8202 Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8203 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8204 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8205 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8206 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8207 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8208
8209 @lisp
8210 @group
8211 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8212 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8213 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8214 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8215 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8216 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8217 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8218 ("N" search ""
8219 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8220 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8221 @end group
8222 @end lisp
8223
8224 @noindent
8225 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8226 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8227 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8228 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8229 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8230 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8231 to only a single file.
8232
8233 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8234 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8235 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8236 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8237 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8238 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8239 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8240 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8241 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8242 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8243 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8244
8245 @lisp
8246 @group
8247 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8248 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8249 ((agenda)
8250 (tags-todo "home")
8251 (tags "garden"
8252 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8253 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8254 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8255 ((agenda)
8256 (tags-todo "work")
8257 (tags "office")))))
8258 @end group
8259 @end lisp
8260
8261 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8262 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8263 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8264 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8265 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8266 yourself.
8267
8268
8269 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8270 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8271 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8272
8273 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8274 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can export custom
8275 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8276 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8277 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8278 a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8279 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8280
8281 @table @kbd
8282 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8283 @cindex exporting agenda views
8284 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8285 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8286 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8287 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8288 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8289 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8290 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8291 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8292
8293 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8294 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8295 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8296 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8297 @lisp
8298 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8299 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8300 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8301 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8302 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8303 @end lisp
8304 @end table
8305
8306 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8307 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8308 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8309 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8310 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8311 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8312 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8313 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8314 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8315 or absolute.
8316
8317 @lisp
8318 @group
8319 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8320 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8321 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8322 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8323 ((agenda "")
8324 (tags-todo "home")
8325 (tags "garden"))
8326 nil
8327 ("~/views/home.html"))
8328 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8329 ((agenda)
8330 (tags-todo "work")
8331 (tags "office"))
8332 nil
8333 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8334 @end group
8335 @end lisp
8336
8337 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8338 @file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8339 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8340 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8341 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8342 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8343 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8344 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8345
8346 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8347 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8348 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8349 files in one step:
8350
8351 @table @kbd
8352 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8353 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8354 them.
8355 @end table
8356
8357 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8358 set options for the export commands. For example:
8359
8360 @lisp
8361 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8362 '(("X" agenda ""
8363 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8364 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8365 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8366 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8367 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8368 ("theagenda.ps"))))
8369 @end lisp
8370
8371 @noindent
8372 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8373 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8374 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8375 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8376 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8377 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8378 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8379 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8380 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8381
8382 @noindent
8383 From the command line you may also use
8384 @example
8385 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
8386 @end example
8387 @noindent
8388 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8389 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8390 @example
8391 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8392 org-agenda-span month \
8393 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8394 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8395 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8396 -kill
8397 @end example
8398 @noindent
8399 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8400 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8401 extent.
8402
8403 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8404 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8405 more information.
8406
8407
8408 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8409 @section Using column view in the agenda
8410 @cindex column view, in agenda
8411 @cindex agenda, column view
8412
8413 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8414 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8415 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8416 collected by certain criteria.
8417
8418 @table @kbd
8419 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8420 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8421 @end table
8422
8423 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8424 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8425 This causes the following issues:
8426
8427 @enumerate
8428 @item
8429 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8430 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8431 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8432 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8433 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8434 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
8435 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8436 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8437 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8438 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8439 @item
8440 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8441 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8442 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8443 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8444 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8445 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8446 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8447 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8448 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8449 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8450 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8451 some values will count double.
8452 @item
8453 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8454 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8455 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8456 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8457 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8458 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8459 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8460 the agenda).
8461 @end enumerate
8462
8463
8464 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8465 @chapter Markup for rich export
8466
8467 When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8468 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8469 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8470 Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8471 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
8472
8473 @menu
8474 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8475 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8476 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8477 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8478 * Index entries:: Making an index
8479 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8480 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8481 @end menu
8482
8483 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8484 @section Structural markup elements
8485
8486 @menu
8487 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8488 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8489 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8490 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8491 * Lists:: Lists
8492 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8493 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8494 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8495 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8496 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8497 @end menu
8498
8499 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8500 @subheading Document title
8501 @cindex document title, markup rules
8502
8503 @noindent
8504 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8505
8506 @cindex #+TITLE
8507 @example
8508 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8509 @end example
8510
8511 @noindent
8512 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8513 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8514 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8515 title will be the file name without extension.
8516
8517 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8518 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8519 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8520 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8521
8522 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8523 @subheading Headings and sections
8524 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8525
8526 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8527 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8528 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8529 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8530 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8531 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8532 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8533 per-file basis with a line
8534
8535 @cindex #+OPTIONS
8536 @example
8537 #+OPTIONS: H:4
8538 @end example
8539
8540 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8541 @subheading Table of contents
8542 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8543
8544 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8545 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8546 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8547 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8548 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8549 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8550 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8551 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8552
8553 @example
8554 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8555 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8556 @end example
8557
8558 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8559 @subheading Text before the first headline
8560 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8561 @cindex #+TEXT
8562
8563 Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8564 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8565 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8566 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8567
8568 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8569 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8570 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8571 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8572 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8573 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8574
8575 @noindent
8576 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8577 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8578
8579 @example
8580 #+OPTIONS: skip:t
8581 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8582 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8583 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
8584 @end example
8585
8586 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8587 @subheading Lists
8588 @cindex lists, markup rules
8589
8590 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8591 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8592 description lists.
8593
8594 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8595 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8596 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8597
8598 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8599 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8600
8601 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8602 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8603
8604 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8605 @example
8606 #+BEGIN_VERSE
8607 Great clouds overhead
8608 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8609 Snow covers Emacs
8610
8611 -- AlexSchroeder
8612 #+END_VERSE
8613 @end example
8614
8615 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8616 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8617 can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
8618
8619 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8620 @example
8621 #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8622 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8623 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8624 #+END_QUOTE
8625 @end example
8626
8627 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8628 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8629 @example
8630 #+BEGIN_CENTER
8631 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8632 but not any simpler
8633 #+END_CENTER
8634 @end example
8635
8636
8637 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8638 @subheading Footnote markup
8639 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8640 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8641
8642 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
8643 all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8644 different backends support this to varying degrees.
8645
8646 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8647 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
8648
8649 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
8650 @cindex bold text, markup rules
8651 @cindex italic text, markup rules
8652 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8653 @cindex code text, markup rules
8654 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8655 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8656 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8657 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
8658 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
8659
8660 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8661 @subheading Horizontal rules
8662 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8663 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
8664 exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
8665
8666 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8667 @subheading Comment lines
8668 @cindex comment lines
8669 @cindex exporting, not
8670 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8671
8672 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8673 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8674 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8675 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8676 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
8677
8678 @table @kbd
8679 @kindex C-c ;
8680 @item C-c ;
8681 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
8682 @end table
8683
8684
8685 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
8686 @section Images and Tables
8687
8688 @cindex tables, markup rules
8689 @cindex #+CAPTION
8690 @cindex #+LABEL
8691 Both the native Org-mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
8692 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org-mode tables,
8693 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
8694 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
8695 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
8696 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
8697
8698 @example
8699 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
8700 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
8701 | ... | ...|
8702 |-----|----|
8703 @end example
8704
8705 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
8706 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
8707 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
8708 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
8709 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
8710 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
8711 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
8712
8713 @example
8714 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
8715 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8716 [[./img/a.jpg]]
8717 @end example
8718
8719 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
8720 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
8721 information.
8722
8723 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
8724
8725 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
8726 @section Literal examples
8727 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
8728 @cindex code line references, markup rules
8729
8730 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
8731 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
8732 for source code and similar examples.
8733 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8734
8735 @example
8736 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8737 Some example from a text file.
8738 #+END_EXAMPLE
8739 @end example
8740
8741 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
8742 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
8743 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
8744 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
8745 whitespace before the colon:
8746
8747 @example
8748 Here is an example
8749 : Some example from a text file.
8750 @end example
8751
8752 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
8753 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
8754 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
8755 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
8756 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
8757 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in LaTeX can be
8758 achieved using either the listings or the
8759 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. To use listings, turn
8760 on the variable @code{org-export-latex-listings} and ensure that the listings
8761 package is included by the LaTeX header (e.g. by configuring
8762 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}). See the listings documentation for
8763 configuration options, including obtaining colored output. For minted it is
8764 necessary to install the program @url{http://pygments.org, pygments}, in
8765 addition to setting @code{org-export-latex-minted}, ensuring that the minted
8766 package is included by the LaTeX header, and ensuring that the
8767 @code{-shell-escape} option is passed to @file{pdflatex} (see
8768 @code{org-latex-to-pdf-process}). See the documentation of the variables
8769 @code{org-export-latex-listings} and @code{org-export-latex-minted} for
8770 further details.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also
8771 need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
8772 example:
8773 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
8774
8775 @example
8776 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
8777 (defun org-xor (a b)
8778 "Exclusive or."
8779 (if a (not b) b))
8780 #+END_SRC
8781 @end example
8782
8783 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
8784 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
8785 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
8786 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
8787 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
8788 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference name
8789 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
8790 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
8791 cool.
8792
8793 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
8794 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
8795 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
8796 be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
8797 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
8798 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
8799 Here is an example:
8800
8801 @example
8802 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
8803 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
8804 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
8805 #+END_SRC
8806 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
8807 jumps to point-min.
8808 @end example
8809
8810 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
8811 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
8812 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
8813 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
8814
8815 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
8816 areas in HTML export}.
8817
8818 @table @kbd
8819 @kindex C-c '
8820 @item C-c '
8821 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
8822 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
8823 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
8824 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
8825 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
8826 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}. The edited version will
8827 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
8828 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
8829 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
8830 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
8831 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
8832 fixed-width region.
8833 @kindex C-c l
8834 @item C-c l
8835 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
8836 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
8837 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
8838 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
8839 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
8840 @end table
8841
8842
8843 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
8844 @section Include files
8845 @cindex include files, markup rules
8846
8847 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
8848 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
8849 @cindex #+INCLUDE
8850
8851 @example
8852 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
8853 @end example
8854 @noindent
8855 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. @samp{quote},
8856 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
8857 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
8858 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be
8859 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
8860 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
8861 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
8862 org-mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
8863 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
8864 use
8865
8866 @example
8867 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
8868 @end example
8869
8870 @table @kbd
8871 @kindex C-c '
8872 @item C-c '
8873 Visit the include file at point.
8874 @end table
8875
8876 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
8877 @section Index entries
8878 @cindex index entries, for publishing
8879
8880 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
8881 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
8882 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
8883 an index} for more information.
8884
8885 @example
8886 * Curriculum Vitae
8887 #+INDEX: CV
8888 #+INDEX: Application!CV
8889 @end example
8890
8891
8892
8893
8894 @node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Index entries, Markup
8895 @section Macro replacement
8896 @cindex macro replacement, during export
8897 @cindex #+MACRO
8898
8899 You can define text snippets with
8900
8901 @example
8902 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
8903 @end example
8904
8905 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
8906 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
8907 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
8908 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
8909 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
8910 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
8911 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
8912 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
8913 @code{format-time-string}.
8914
8915 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
8916 construct complex HTML code.
8917
8918
8919 @node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
8920 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
8921 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
8922 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
8923
8924 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
8925 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
8926 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
8927 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
8928 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
8929 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org-mode
8930 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
8931 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
8932 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
8933
8934 @menu
8935 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
8936 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
8937 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
8938 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
8939 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
8940 @end menu
8941
8942 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
8943 @subsection Special symbols
8944 @cindex math symbols
8945 @cindex special symbols
8946 @cindex @TeX{} macros
8947 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
8948 @cindex HTML entities
8949 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
8950
8951 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
8952 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
8953 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
8954 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
8955 code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
8956 delimiters, for example:
8957
8958 @example
8959 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
8960 @end example
8961
8962 @vindex org-entities
8963 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
8964 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
8965 @code{&alpha;} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
8966 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and
8967 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
8968 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
8969
8970 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
8971 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
8972 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
8973 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
8974 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
8975
8976 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
8977 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
8978 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
8979 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
8980
8981 @table @kbd
8982 @kindex C-c C-x \
8983 @item C-c C-x \
8984 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
8985 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
8986 for display purposes only.
8987 @end table
8988
8989 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
8990 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
8991 @cindex subscript
8992 @cindex superscript
8993
8994 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
8995 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
8996 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
8997 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
8998 with curly braces. For example
8999
9000 @example
9001 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9002 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9003 @end example
9004
9005 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9006 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9007 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9008 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9009 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9010 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9011 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9012
9013 @example
9014 #+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}
9015 @end example
9016
9017 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9018 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9019
9020 @table @kbd
9021 @kindex C-c C-x \
9022 @item C-c C-x \
9023 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9024 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9025 @end table
9026
9027 @node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
9028 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9029 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9030
9031 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9032 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9033 needed. Org-mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9034 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9035 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9036 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9037 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9038 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9039 @file{MathJax} on your own
9040 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9041 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9042 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9043 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
9044 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The @LaTeX{} header that will
9045 be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9046 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9047 DocBook documents.
9048
9049 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9050 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9051 @itemize @bullet
9052 @item
9053 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9054 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9055 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9056 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9057 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9058 @item
9059 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9060 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9061 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9062 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9063 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9064 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9065 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9066 @end itemize
9067
9068 @noindent For example:
9069
9070 @example
9071 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9072 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9073 \end@{equation@} % etc
9074
9075 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9076 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9077 @end example
9078
9079 @noindent
9080 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9081 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9082 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9083 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9084
9085 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9086 LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable
9087 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9088 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9089 LaTeX backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9090 of these lines:
9091
9092 @example
9093 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9094 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9095 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9096 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9097 @end example
9098
9099 @node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9100 @subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
9101 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
9102
9103 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9104 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9105
9106 @table @kbd
9107 @kindex C-c C-x C-l
9108 @item C-c C-x C-l
9109 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9110 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9111 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9112 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9113 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9114 process the entire buffer.
9115 @kindex C-c C-c
9116 @item C-c C-c
9117 Remove the overlay preview images.
9118 @end table
9119
9120 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9121 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9122 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9123 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9124 preview images.
9125
9126 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9127 @subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
9128 @cindex CDLa@TeX{}
9129
9130 CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9131 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9132 environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
9133 some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
9134 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9135 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9136 Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light
9137 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it
9138 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9139 Org files with
9140
9141 @lisp
9142 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9143 @end lisp
9144
9145 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9146 details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
9147 @itemize @bullet
9148 @kindex C-c @{
9149 @item
9150 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9151 @item
9152 @kindex @key{TAB}
9153 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9154 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9155 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9156 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9157 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9158 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9159 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9160 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9161 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9162 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9163 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9164 @item
9165 @kindex _
9166 @kindex ^
9167 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9168 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9169 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9170 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9171 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9172 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9173 @item
9174 @kindex `
9175 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9176 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9177 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9178 @item
9179 @kindex '
9180 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9181 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9182 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9183 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9184 is normal.
9185 @end itemize
9186
9187 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9188 @chapter Exporting
9189 @cindex exporting
9190
9191 Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9192 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9193 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9194 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9195 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org-mode and
9196 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9197 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9198 DocBook tools. For project management you can create gantt and resource
9199 charts by using TaskJuggler export. To incorporate entries with associated
9200 times like deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like
9201 iCal, Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
9202 Org-mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
9203
9204 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9205 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9206
9207 @menu
9208 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9209 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9210 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9211 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9212 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9213 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9214 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9215 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9216 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9217 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9218 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9219 @end menu
9220
9221 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9222 @section Selective export
9223 @cindex export, selective by tags
9224
9225 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9226 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9227 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9228 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9229 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
9230
9231 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
9232 If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
9233 selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
9234 selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9235
9236 @noindent
9237 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9238 export.
9239
9240 @noindent
9241 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9242 be removed from the export buffer.
9243
9244 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9245 @section Export options
9246 @cindex options, for export
9247
9248 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9249 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9250 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9251 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9252 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9253 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9254 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9255 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9256 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9257 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9258
9259 @table @kbd
9260 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9261 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9262 @end table
9263
9264 @cindex #+TITLE
9265 @cindex #+AUTHOR
9266 @cindex #+DATE
9267 @cindex #+EMAIL
9268 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9269 @cindex #+KEYWORDS
9270 @cindex #+LANGUAGE
9271 @cindex #+TEXT
9272 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9273 @cindex #+BIND
9274 @cindex #+LINK_UP
9275 @cindex #+LINK_HOME
9276 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9277 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9278 @cindex #+XSLT
9279 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9280 @vindex user-full-name
9281 @vindex user-mail-address
9282 @vindex org-export-default-language
9283 @example
9284 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9285 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9286 #+DATE: a date, fixed, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9287 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9288 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9289 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
9290 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9291 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9292 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9293 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9294 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
9295 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9296 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9297 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9298 #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9299 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9300 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9301 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9302 @end example
9303
9304 @noindent
9305 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9306 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export
9307 settings. Here you can:
9308 @cindex headline levels
9309 @cindex section-numbers
9310 @cindex table of contents
9311 @cindex line-break preservation
9312 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9313 @cindex fixed-width sections
9314 @cindex tables
9315 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9316 @cindex footnotes
9317 @cindex special strings
9318 @cindex emphasized text
9319 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9320 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9321 @cindex author info, in export
9322 @cindex time info, in export
9323 @example
9324 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9325 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9326 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9327 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9328 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9329 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9330 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9331 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9332 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9333 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9334 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9335 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9336 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9337 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9338 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9339 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9340 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9341 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9342 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9343 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9344 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9345 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9346 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9347 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9348 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
9349 @end example
9350 @noindent
9351 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9352 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and @code{nil}
9353 for the @LaTeX{} export. The default values for these and many other options
9354 are given by a set of variables. For a list of such variables, the
9355 corresponding OPTIONS keys and also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project
9356 alist}), see the constant @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9357
9358 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9359 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9360 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9361 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9362 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9363
9364 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9365 @section The export dispatcher
9366 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9367
9368 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9369 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9370 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9371 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9372 the subtrees are exported.
9373
9374 @table @kbd
9375 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9376 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9377 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9378 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9379 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9380 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9381 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9382 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9383 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9384 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9385 (i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
9386 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9387 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9388 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9389 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
9390 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9391 @end table
9392
9393 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9394 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9395 @cindex ASCII export
9396 @cindex Latin-1 export
9397 @cindex UTF-8 export
9398
9399 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
9400 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9401 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9402
9403 @cindex region, active
9404 @cindex active region
9405 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9406 @table @kbd
9407 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9408 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9409 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9410 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9411 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9412 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9413 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9414 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9415 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9416 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9417 export.
9418 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
9419 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9420 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
9421 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
9422 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9423 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
9424 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
9425 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9426 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
9427 Export only the visible part of the document.
9428 @end table
9429
9430 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9431 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9432 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9433 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9434 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9435
9436 @example
9437 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
9438 @end example
9439
9440 @noindent
9441 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9442 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9443 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9444 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9445 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9446 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9447 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9448
9449 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9450 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9451 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9452 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9453
9454 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9455 @section HTML export
9456 @cindex HTML export
9457
9458 Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9459 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9460 language, but with additional support for tables.
9461
9462 @menu
9463 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9464 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
9465 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9466 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9467 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9468 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
9469 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9470 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9471 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9472 @end menu
9473
9474 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
9475 @subsection HTML export commands
9476
9477 @cindex region, active
9478 @cindex active region
9479 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9480 @table @kbd
9481 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
9482 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9483 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9484 the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9485 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9486 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9487 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9488 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9489 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9490 property, that name will be used for the export.
9491 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
9492 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9493 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
9494 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9495 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
9496 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9497 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9498 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9499 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
9500 Export only the visible part of the document.
9501 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9502 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9503 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9504 buffer.
9505 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9506 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
9507 code.
9508 @end table
9509
9510 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9511 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9512 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9513 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9514 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9515
9516 @example
9517 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
9518 @end example
9519
9520 @noindent
9521 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9522
9523 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9524 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9525
9526 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
9527 @samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9528 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9529 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9530 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9531 the exported file use either
9532
9533 @cindex #+HTML
9534 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9535 @example
9536 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9537 @end example
9538
9539 @noindent or
9540 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9541
9542 @example
9543 #+BEGIN_HTML
9544 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9545 #+END_HTML
9546 @end example
9547
9548
9549 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9550 @subsection Links in HTML export
9551
9552 @cindex links, in HTML export
9553 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9554 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9555 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9556 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9557 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9558 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9559 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9560 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9561 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9562 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9563 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
9564
9565 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
9566 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
9567 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9568 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
9569
9570 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
9571 @example
9572 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9573 [[http://orgmode.org]]
9574 @end example
9575
9576 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
9577 @subsection Tables
9578 @cindex tables, in HTML
9579 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9580
9581 Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9582 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9583 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9584 tables, place something like the following before the table:
9585
9586 @cindex #+CAPTION
9587 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
9588 @example
9589 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9590 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
9591 @end example
9592
9593 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
9594 @subsection Images in HTML export
9595
9596 @cindex images, inline in HTML
9597 @cindex inlining images in HTML
9598 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
9599 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
9600 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
9601 default@footnote{But see the variable
9602 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
9603 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
9604 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
9605 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
9606 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
9607 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
9608 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
9609 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
9610
9611 @example
9612 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
9613 @end example
9614
9615 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
9616 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
9617 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
9618
9619 @cindex #+CAPTION
9620 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
9621 @example
9622 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
9623 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
9624 [[./img/a.jpg]]
9625 @end example
9626
9627 @noindent
9628 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
9629
9630 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
9631 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
9632 @cindex MathJax
9633 @cindex dvipng
9634
9635 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{LaTeX fragments}) can be displayed in two
9636 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
9637 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
9638 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
9639 @file{MathJax} for Org-mode users for small applications and for testing
9640 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
9641 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
9642 found on the MathJax website, see
9643 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
9644 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
9645 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
9646 insert something like the following into the buffer:
9647
9648 @example
9649 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
9650 @end example
9651
9652 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
9653 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
9654 this line.
9655
9656 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
9657 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
9658 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
9659 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
9660 You can still get this processing with
9661
9662 @example
9663 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
9664 @end example
9665
9666 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
9667 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
9668
9669 @cindex text areas, in HTML
9670 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
9671 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
9672 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
9673 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
9674 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
9675 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
9676 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
9677 respectively. For example
9678
9679 @example
9680 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
9681 (defun org-xor (a b)
9682 "Exclusive or."
9683 (if a (not b) b))
9684 #+END_EXAMPLE
9685 @end example
9686
9687
9688 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
9689 @subsection CSS support
9690 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
9691 @cindex HTML export, CSS
9692
9693 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
9694 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
9695 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
9696 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
9697 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
9698 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
9699 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
9700 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
9701 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
9702 @example
9703 p.author @r{author information, including email}
9704 p.date @r{publishing date}
9705 p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
9706 .title @r{document title}
9707 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
9708 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done}
9709 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
9710 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
9711 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
9712 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
9713 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
9714 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
9715 .target @r{target for links}
9716 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
9717 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
9718 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
9719 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
9720 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
9721 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
9722 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
9723 pre.example @r{normal example}
9724 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
9725 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
9726 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
9727 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
9728 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
9729 @end example
9730
9731 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9732 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
9733 @vindex org-export-html-style
9734 @vindex org-export-html-extra
9735 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9736 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
9737 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
9738 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
9739 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
9740 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
9741 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
9742 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
9743 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
9744 individually for each file, you can use
9745
9746 @cindex #+STYLE
9747 @example
9748 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
9749 @end example
9750
9751 @noindent
9752 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
9753 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
9754 referring to an external file.
9755
9756 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
9757 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
9758 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
9759 property.
9760
9761 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
9762 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
9763
9764 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
9765 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
9766
9767 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
9768 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
9769 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
9770 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
9771 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
9772 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
9773 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
9774 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
9775 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
9776 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
9777 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
9778 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
9779 copy on your own web server.
9780
9781 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
9782 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
9783 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
9784 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
9785 adding a single line to the Org file:
9786
9787 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
9788 @example
9789 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
9790 @end example
9791
9792 @noindent
9793 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
9794 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
9795 viewing options:
9796
9797 @example
9798 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
9799 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
9800 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
9801 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
9802 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
9803 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
9804 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
9805 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
9806 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
9807 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
9808 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
9809 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
9810 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
9811 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
9812 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
9813 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
9814 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
9815 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
9816 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
9817 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
9818 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
9819 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
9820 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
9821 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
9822 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
9823 @end example
9824 @noindent
9825 @vindex org-infojs-options
9826 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
9827 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
9828 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
9829 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
9830
9831 @node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
9832 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
9833 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
9834 @cindex PDF export
9835 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
9836
9837 Org-mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
9838 further processing@footnote{The default LaTeX output is designed for
9839 processing with pdftex or latex. It includes packages that are not
9840 compatible with xetex and possibly luatex. See the variables
9841 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9842 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
9843 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
9844 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
9845 linked.
9846
9847 @menu
9848 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
9849 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
9850 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
9851 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
9852 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
9853 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
9854 @end menu
9855
9856 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
9857 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
9858
9859 @cindex region, active
9860 @cindex active region
9861 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9862 @table @kbd
9863 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
9864 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9865 Export as @LaTeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
9866 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
9867 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
9868 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9869 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9870 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9871 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9872 property, that name will be used for the export.
9873 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
9874 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9875 @item C-c C-e v l/L
9876 Export only the visible part of the document.
9877 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
9878 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9879 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9880 buffer.
9881 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
9882 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
9883 code.
9884 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
9885 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
9886 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
9887 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
9888 @end table
9889
9890 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9891 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
9892 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9893 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9894 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
9895 convert them to a custom string depending on
9896 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
9897
9898 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
9899 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9900
9901 @example
9902 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
9903 @end example
9904
9905 @noindent
9906 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9907
9908 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
9909 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
9910 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
9911 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
9912 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
9913 @cindex header, for LaTeX files
9914 @cindex sectioning structure, for LaTeX export
9915
9916 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
9917
9918 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
9919 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
9920 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
9921 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
9922 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9923 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
9924 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9925 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
9926 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9927 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
9928 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
9929 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
9930 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
9931 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
9932 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
9933 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9934 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
9935 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
9936 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
9937 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
9938 can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
9939 header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
9940 information.
9941
9942 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Tables in LaTeX export, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export
9943 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
9944
9945 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
9946 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
9947 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
9948 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
9949 the following constructs:
9950
9951 @cindex #+LaTeX
9952 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9953 @example
9954 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
9955 @end example
9956
9957 @noindent or
9958 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9959
9960 @example
9961 #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9962 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9963 #+END_LaTeX
9964 @end example
9965
9966
9967 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
9968 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
9969 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
9970
9971 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
9972 (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
9973 request a @code{longtable} environment for the table, so that it may span
9974 several pages, or provide the @code{multicolumn} keyword that will make the
9975 table span the page in a multicolumn environment (@code{table*} environment).
9976 Finally, you can set the alignment string:
9977
9978 @cindex #+CAPTION
9979 @cindex #+LABEL
9980 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9981 @example
9982 #+CAPTION: A long table
9983 #+LABEL: tbl:long
9984 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
9985 | ..... | ..... |
9986 | ..... | ..... |
9987 @end example
9988
9989
9990 @node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
9991 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
9992 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
9993 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
9994
9995 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
9996 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
9997 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
9998 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
9999 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10000 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10001 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
10002 options that can be used in the optional argument of the
10003 @code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
10004 @code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
10005 Attributes.
10006
10007 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10008 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10009 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10010 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10011 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10012 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10013
10014 @cindex #+CAPTION
10015 @cindex #+LABEL
10016 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10017 @example
10018 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10019 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10020 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10021 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10022
10023 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10024 [[./img/hst.png]]
10025 @end example
10026
10027 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10028 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10029
10030 @node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
10031 @subsection Beamer class export
10032
10033 The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10034 using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
10035 Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10036
10037 When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10038 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10039 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10040 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10041 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10042 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10043 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10044 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10045 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10046 structure of the presentation.
10047
10048 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10049 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10050 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10051 editing special properties used by beamer.
10052
10053 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10054 properties:
10055
10056 @table @code
10057 @item BEAMER_env
10058 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10059 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10060 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10061 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10062 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10063 @item BEAMER_envargs
10064 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10065 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10066 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10067 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10068 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10069 environment.
10070 @item BEAMER_col
10071 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10072 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10073 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10074 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10075 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10076 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10077 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10078 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10079 @item BEAMER_extra
10080 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10081 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10082 transitions.
10083 @end table
10084
10085 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10086 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10087 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10088 @code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
10089 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10090 in the presentation as well.
10091
10092 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10093 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10094 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10095 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10096 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10097 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10098 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10099
10100 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10101 support with
10102
10103 @example
10104 #+STARTUP: beamer
10105 @end example
10106
10107 @table @kbd
10108 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10109 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10110 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10111 @end table
10112
10113 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10114 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10115 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10116 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10117
10118 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10119
10120 @smallexample
10121 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10122 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10123 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10124 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10125 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10126 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10127 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10128
10129 * This is the first structural section
10130
10131 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10132 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10133 :PROPERTIES:
10134 :BEAMER_env: block
10135 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10136 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
10137 :END:
10138 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10139 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10140 :PROPERTIES:
10141 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
10142 :BEAMER_env: block
10143 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10144 :END:
10145 for contributing to the discussion
10146 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10147 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10148 *** Request :B_block:
10149 Please test this stuff!
10150 :PROPERTIES:
10151 :BEAMER_env: block
10152 :END:
10153 @end smallexample
10154
10155 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10156
10157 @node DocBook export, TaskJuggler export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
10158 @section DocBook export
10159 @cindex DocBook export
10160 @cindex PDF export
10161 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10162
10163 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10164 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10165 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10166 tools and stylesheets.
10167
10168 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10169
10170 @menu
10171 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10172 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10173 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10174 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10175 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10176 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10177 @end menu
10178
10179 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10180 @subsection DocBook export commands
10181
10182 @cindex region, active
10183 @cindex active region
10184 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10185 @table @kbd
10186 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10187 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10188 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10189 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10190 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10191 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10192 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10193 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10194 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10195 property, that name will be used for the export.
10196 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10197 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10198
10199 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10200 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10201 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
10202 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10203 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10204 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10205
10206 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10207 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10208 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10209 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10210 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10211 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10212
10213 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10214 Export only the visible part of the document.
10215 @end table
10216
10217 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10218 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10219
10220 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10221 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10222
10223 @cindex #+DOCBOOK
10224 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10225 @example
10226 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10227 @end example
10228
10229 @noindent or
10230 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10231
10232 @example
10233 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10234 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10235 literally.
10236 #+END_DOCBOOK
10237 @end example
10238
10239 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10240 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10241 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10242 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10243
10244 @example
10245 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10246 <warning>
10247 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10248 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10249 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10250 </warning>
10251 #+END_DOCBOOK
10252 @end example
10253
10254 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10255 @subsection Recursive sections
10256 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10257
10258 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10259 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. @code{section} elements, are
10260 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10261 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10262 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10263 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10264
10265 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10266 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10267
10268 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10269 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10270 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10271
10272 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10273 DocBook V4.3.
10274
10275 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10276 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10277 using the @code{table} element.
10278
10279 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10280 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10281 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10282 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10283
10284 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10285 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10286 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10287 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10288 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10289 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10290 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10291 @code{mediaobject} element.
10292
10293 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10294 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10295 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10296 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10297 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10298 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10299 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10300 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10301
10302 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10303 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10304 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10305 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10306 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10307 set:
10308
10309 @cindex #+CAPTION
10310 @cindex #+LABEL
10311 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10312 @example
10313 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
10314 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10315 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10316 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10317 @end example
10318
10319 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10320 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10321 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10322 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10323 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10324
10325 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10326 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10327 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10328
10329 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10330 @vindex org-entities
10331 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10332 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10333 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{&alpha;},
10334 @code{&Gamma;}, and @code{&Zeta;}, based on the list saved in variable
10335 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10336 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10337
10338 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10339 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10340 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10341 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10342
10343 @example
10344 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10345 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10346 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10347 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10348 >
10349 %xhtml1-symbol;
10350 ]>
10351 "
10352 @end example
10353
10354 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, DocBook export, Exporting
10355 @section TaskJuggler export
10356 @cindex TaskJuggler export
10357 @cindex Project management
10358
10359 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
10360 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
10361 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
10362 you have provided.
10363
10364 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
10365 HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
10366 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
10367 document.
10368
10369 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
10370 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
10371 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
10372 all the nodes.
10373
10374 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
10375
10376 @table @kbd
10377 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
10378 Export as TaskJuggler file.
10379
10380 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
10381 Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
10382 @end table
10383
10384 @subsection Tasks
10385
10386 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
10387 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to each
10388 task using properties (it's easiest to do this in the column view). You
10389 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
10390 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
10391 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
10392 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
10393 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
10394 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
10395 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
10396
10397 @subsection Resources
10398
10399 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
10400 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
10401 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
10402 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
10403 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
10404 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
10405 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
10406 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
10407 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
10408 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
10409 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
10410 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
10411 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
10412
10413 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
10414 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
10415 time.
10416
10417 @subsection Export of properties
10418
10419 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e. if a
10420 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
10421 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
10422 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
10423 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
10424 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
10425 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
10426 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
10427 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
10428
10429 @subsection Dependencies
10430
10431 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
10432 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
10433 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
10434 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
10435 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
10436 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
10437 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
10438 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
10439 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
10440 examples should illustrate this:
10441
10442 @example
10443 * Preparation
10444 :PROPERTIES:
10445 :task_id: preparation
10446 :ORDERED: t
10447 :END:
10448 * Training material
10449 :PROPERTIES:
10450 :task_id: training_material
10451 :ORDERED: t
10452 :END:
10453 ** Markup Guidelines
10454 :PROPERTIES:
10455 :Effort: 2.0
10456 :END:
10457 ** Workflow Guidelines
10458 :PROPERTIES:
10459 :Effort: 2.0
10460 :END:
10461 * Presentation
10462 :PROPERTIES:
10463 :Effort: 2.0
10464 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
10465 :END:
10466 @end example
10467
10468 @subsection Reports
10469
10470 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
10471 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g. gantt chart, resource
10472 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
10473 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
10474 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
10475 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
10476 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
10477 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
10478
10479 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
10480 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.php}.
10481
10482 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
10483 @section Freemind export
10484 @cindex Freemind export
10485 @cindex mind map
10486
10487 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
10488
10489 @table @kbd
10490 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
10491 Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
10492 @end table
10493
10494 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
10495 @section XOXO export
10496 @cindex XOXO export
10497
10498 Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
10499 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
10500 does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
10501
10502 @table @kbd
10503 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
10504 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
10505 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
10506 Export only the visible part of the document.
10507 @end table
10508
10509 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
10510 @section iCalendar export
10511 @cindex iCalendar export
10512
10513 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
10514 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
10515 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
10516 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
10517 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
10518 Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
10519 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
10520 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
10521 files in the calendar application. Org-mode can export calendar information
10522 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
10523 included in the export, configure the variable
10524 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
10525 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
10526 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
10527 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
10528 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
10529 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
10530 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
10531 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
10532 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
10533 time.
10534
10535 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
10536 @cindex property, ID
10537 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
10538 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
10539 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
10540 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
10541 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
10542 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
10543 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
10544 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
10545 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
10546
10547 @table @kbd
10548 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
10549 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
10550 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
10551 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
10552 @vindex org-agenda-files
10553 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
10554 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
10555 file will be written.
10556 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
10557 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
10558 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
10559 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
10560 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
10561 @end table
10562
10563 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
10564 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
10565 @cindex property, SUMMARY
10566 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
10567 @cindex property, LOCATION
10568 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
10569 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
10570 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
10571 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
10572 and the description from the body (limited to
10573 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
10574
10575 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
10576 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
10577
10578 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
10579 @chapter Publishing
10580 @cindex publishing
10581
10582 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
10583 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
10584 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
10585 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
10586 server.
10587
10588 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
10589 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
10590
10591 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
10592
10593 @menu
10594 * Configuration:: Defining projects
10595 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
10596 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
10597 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
10598 @end menu
10599
10600 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
10601 @section Configuration
10602
10603 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
10604 and many other properties of a project.
10605
10606 @menu
10607 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
10608 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
10609 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
10610 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
10611 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
10612 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
10613 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
10614 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
10615 @end menu
10616
10617 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
10618 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
10619 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
10620 @cindex projects, for publishing
10621
10622 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10623 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
10624 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
10625 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
10626
10627 @lisp
10628 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
10629 @r{i.e. a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
10630 @r{or}
10631 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
10632
10633 @end lisp
10634
10635 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
10636 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
10637 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
10638 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
10639 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
10640 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
10641 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
10642 sequence given.
10643
10644 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
10645 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
10646 @cindex directories, for publishing
10647
10648 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
10649 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
10650 and where to put published files.
10651
10652 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10653 @item @code{:base-directory}
10654 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
10655 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
10656 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
10657 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
10658 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
10659 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
10660 @item @code{:preparation-function}
10661 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
10662 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
10663 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
10664 variable @code{project-plist}.
10665 @item @code{:completion-function}
10666 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
10667 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
10668 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
10669 @code{project-plist}.
10670 @end multitable
10671 @noindent
10672
10673 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
10674 @subsection Selecting files
10675 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
10676
10677 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
10678 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
10679 properties
10680 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10681 @item @code{:base-extension}
10682 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
10683 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
10684 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
10685
10686 @item @code{:exclude}
10687 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
10688 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
10689 extension.
10690
10691 @item @code{:include}
10692 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
10693 and @code{:exclude}.
10694
10695 @item @code{:recursive}
10696 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
10697 @end multitable
10698
10699 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
10700 @subsection Publishing action
10701 @cindex action, for publishing
10702
10703 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
10704 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
10705 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
10706 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
10707 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
10708 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
10709 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
10710 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
10711 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
10712 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
10713 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
10714 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
10715 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
10716 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
10717 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
10718 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
10719 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
10720 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
10721 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
10722
10723 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10724 @item @code{:publishing-function}
10725 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
10726 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
10727 @item @code{:plain-source}
10728 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
10729 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
10730 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
10731 @end multitable
10732
10733 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
10734 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
10735 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
10736 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
10737 and place the result into the destination folder.
10738
10739 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
10740 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
10741 @cindex options, for publishing
10742
10743 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
10744 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
10745 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
10746 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
10747 respective variable for details.
10748
10749 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
10750 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
10751 @vindex org-export-default-language
10752 @vindex org-display-custom-times
10753 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
10754 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10755 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
10756 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10757 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10758 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10759 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
10760 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10761 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10762 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10763 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
10764 @vindex org-export-with-tags
10765 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10766 @vindex org-export-with-priority
10767 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
10768 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
10769 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
10770 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10771 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10772 @vindex org-export-author-info
10773 @vindex org-export-email
10774 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10775 @vindex org-export-with-tables
10776 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
10777 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10778 @vindex org-export-html-style
10779 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
10780 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
10781 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10782 @vindex org-export-html-extension
10783 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10784 @vindex org-export-html-expand
10785 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
10786 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
10787 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10788 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10789 @vindex org-export-html-auto-preamble
10790 @vindex org-export-html-auto-postamble
10791 @vindex user-full-name
10792 @vindex user-mail-address
10793 @vindex org-export-select-tags
10794 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
10795
10796 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
10797 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
10798 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
10799 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
10800 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
10801 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
10802 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
10803 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
10804 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
10805 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
10806 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
10807 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
10808 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
10809 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
10810 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
10811 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
10812 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
10813 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
10814 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
10815 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
10816 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
10817 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
10818 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
10819 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
10820 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
10821 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
10822 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
10823 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
10824 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
10825 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
10826 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
10827 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
10828 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
10829 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
10830 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
10831 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
10832 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
10833 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
10834 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
10835 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
10836 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
10837 @item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
10838 @item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
10839 @item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
10840 @item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
10841 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
10842 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
10843 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
10844 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
10845 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
10846 @end multitable
10847
10848 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
10849 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
10850 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
10851 @LaTeX{} export.
10852
10853 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10854 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
10855 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
10856 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
10857 options}), however, override everything.
10858
10859 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
10860 @subsection Links between published files
10861 @cindex links, publishing
10862
10863 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
10864 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
10865 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
10866 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
10867 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
10868 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
10869 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
10870 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
10871 @file{html} file.
10872
10873 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
10874 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
10875 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
10876 an example of this usage.
10877
10878 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
10879 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
10880 location. In this case, use the property
10881
10882 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
10883 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
10884 @tab Function to validate links
10885 @end multitable
10886
10887 @noindent
10888 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
10889 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
10890 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
10891 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
10892 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
10893 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
10894 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
10895
10896 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
10897 @subsection Generating a sitemap
10898 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
10899
10900 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
10901 a map of files for a given project.
10902
10903 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
10904 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
10905 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
10906 or @code{org-publish-all}.
10907
10908 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
10909 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
10910 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
10911
10912 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
10913 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
10914
10915 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
10916 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
10917 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
10918 of links to all files in the project.
10919
10920 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
10921 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
10922 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
10923 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
10924
10925 @item @code{:sitemap-alphabetically}
10926 @tab The site map is normally sorted alphabetically. Set this explicitly to
10927 @code{nil} to turn off sorting.
10928
10929 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
10930 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
10931
10932 @end multitable
10933
10934 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
10935 @subsection Generating an index
10936 @cindex index, in a publishing project
10937
10938 Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
10939
10940 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10941 @item @code{:makeindex}
10942 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
10943 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
10944 @end multitable
10945
10946 The file will be create when first publishing a project with the
10947 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
10948 "theindex.inc"}. You can then built around this include statement by adding
10949 a title, style information etc.
10950
10951 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
10952 @section Uploading files
10953 @cindex rsync
10954 @cindex unison
10955
10956 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
10957 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
10958 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on
10959 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
10960 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
10961 under heavy usage.
10962
10963 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
10964 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
10965 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
10966 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
10967 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
10968
10969 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
10970 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
10971 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
10972 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
10973 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
10974 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
10975 tool syncs them.
10976
10977 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
10978 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
10979 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
10980 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
10981 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
10982 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
10983
10984 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
10985 @section Sample configuration
10986
10987 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
10988 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
10989 more complex, with a multi-component project.
10990
10991 @menu
10992 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
10993 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
10994 @end menu
10995
10996 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
10997 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
10998
10999 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
11000 directory on the local machine.
11001
11002 @lisp
11003 (setq org-publish-project-alist
11004 '(("org"
11005 :base-directory "~/org/"
11006 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
11007 :section-numbers nil
11008 :table-of-contents nil
11009 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
11010 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
11011 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
11012 @end lisp
11013
11014 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
11015 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
11016
11017 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
11018 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
11019 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
11020 excluded.
11021
11022 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
11023 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
11024 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
11025 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
11026 @c
11027 @example
11028 file:../images/myimage.png
11029 @end example
11030 @c
11031 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
11032 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
11033 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
11034
11035 @lisp
11036 (setq org-publish-project-alist
11037 '(("orgfiles"
11038 :base-directory "~/org/"
11039 :base-extension "org"
11040 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
11041 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
11042 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
11043 :headline-levels 3
11044 :section-numbers nil
11045 :table-of-contents nil
11046 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
11047 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
11048 :auto-preamble t
11049 :auto-postamble nil)
11050
11051 ("images"
11052 :base-directory "~/images/"
11053 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
11054 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
11055 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
11056
11057 ("other"
11058 :base-directory "~/other/"
11059 :base-extension "css\\|el"
11060 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
11061 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
11062 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
11063 @end lisp
11064
11065 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
11066 @section Triggering publication
11067
11068 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
11069
11070 @table @kbd
11071 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
11072 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
11073 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
11074 Publish the project containing the current file.
11075 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
11076 Publish only the current file.
11077 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
11078 Publish every project.
11079 @end table
11080
11081 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
11082 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
11083 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
11084 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
11085 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
11086 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
11087 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
11088
11089 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11090 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
11091
11092 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
11093 @chapter Working with source code
11094 @cindex Schulte, Eric
11095 @cindex Davison, Dan
11096 @cindex source code, working with
11097
11098 Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
11099 e.g.
11100
11101 @example
11102 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
11103 (defun org-xor (a b)
11104 "Exclusive or."
11105 (if a (not b) b))
11106 #+END_SRC
11107 @end example
11108
11109 Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
11110 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
11111 code blocks, tangling of code blocks, and exporting code blocks and their
11112 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
11113 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
11114
11115 The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling facilities.
11116
11117 @menu
11118 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
11119 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
11120 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
11121 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
11122 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
11123 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
11124 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
11125 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
11126 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
11127 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
11128 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
11129 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
11130 @end menu
11131
11132 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11133 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11134
11135 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11136 @section Structure of code blocks
11137 @cindex code block, structure
11138 @cindex source code, block structure
11139
11140 The structure of code blocks is as follows:
11141
11142 @example
11143 #+srcname: <name>
11144 #+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
11145 <body>
11146 #+end_src
11147 @end example
11148
11149 code blocks can also be embedded in text as so called inline code blocks as
11150
11151 @example
11152 src_<language>@{<body>@}
11153 @end example
11154
11155 or
11156
11157 @example
11158 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
11159 @end example
11160
11161 @table @code
11162 @item <name>
11163 This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to the
11164 @samp{#+tblname} lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode files.
11165 Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate the
11166 block from other places in the file, other files, or from Org-mode table
11167 formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}).
11168 @item <language>
11169 The language of the code in the block.
11170 @item <switches>
11171 Switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches discussion in
11172 @ref{Literal examples})
11173 @item <header arguments>
11174 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
11175 tangling of code blocks. See the @ref{Header arguments}
11176 section. Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
11177 basis using properties.
11178 @item <body>
11179 The source code.
11180 @end table
11181
11182 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11183 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11184
11185 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11186 @section Editing source code
11187 @cindex code block, editing
11188 @cindex source code, editing
11189
11190 @kindex C-c '
11191 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
11192 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
11193 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
11194 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
11195
11196 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
11197 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
11198 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
11199 further configuration options.
11200
11201 @table @code
11202 @item org-src-lang-modes
11203 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
11204 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
11205 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
11206 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
11207 @item org-src-window-setup
11208 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
11209 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
11210 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
11211 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
11212 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
11213 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set
11214 this variable to nil to switch without asking.
11215 @end table
11216
11217 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11218 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11219
11220 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11221 @section Exporting code blocks
11222 @cindex code block, exporting
11223 @cindex source code, exporting
11224
11225 It is possible to export the @emph{contents} of code blocks, the
11226 @emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{neither}, or @emph{both}. For
11227 most languages, the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for
11228 some languages (e.g. @code{ditaa}) the default exports the results of code
11229 block evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see
11230 @ref{Literal examples}.
11231
11232 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
11233 behavior:
11234
11235 @subsubheading Header arguments:
11236 @table @code
11237 @item :exports code
11238 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
11239 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
11240 @item :exports results
11241 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
11242 Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
11243 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
11244 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
11245 block will not be exported.
11246 @item :exports both
11247 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
11248 @item :exports none
11249 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
11250 @end table
11251
11252 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
11253 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
11254 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
11255 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode files are
11256 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode is used as the
11257 markup language for a wiki.
11258
11259 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11260 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11261 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11262 @section Extracting source code
11263 @cindex source code, extracting
11264 @cindex code block, extracting source code
11265
11266 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
11267 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
11268 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
11269 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
11270 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
11271
11272 @subsubheading Header arguments
11273 @table @code
11274 @item :tangle no
11275 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
11276 @item :tangle yes
11277 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
11278 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
11279 for the block language.
11280 @item :tangle filename
11281 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
11282 @end table
11283
11284 @kindex C-c C-v t
11285 @subsubheading Functions
11286 @table @code
11287 @item org-babel-tangle
11288 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
11289 @item org-babel-tangle-file
11290 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
11291 @end table
11292
11293 @subsubheading Hooks
11294 @table @code
11295 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
11296 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
11297 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
11298 of tangled code files.
11299 @end table
11300
11301 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
11302 @section Evaluating code blocks
11303 @cindex code block, evaluating
11304 @cindex source code, evaluating
11305
11306 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
11307 potential for that code to do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards
11308 to ensure that it only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the
11309 user. For information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see
11310 @ref{Code evaluation security}.} and the results placed in the Org-mode
11311 buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for @code{emacs-lisp} code
11312 blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages. See
11313 @ref{Languages} for a list of supported languages. See @ref{Structure of
11314 code blocks} for information on the syntax used to define a code block.
11315
11316 @kindex C-c C-c
11317 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
11318 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
11319 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
11320 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
11321 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
11322 its results into the Org-mode buffer.
11323
11324 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
11325 Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. @code{#+call} (or synonymously
11326 @code{#+function} or @code{#+lob}) lines can be used to remotely execute code
11327 blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel''
11328 (see @ref{Library of Babel}). These lines use the following syntax.
11329
11330 @example
11331 #+call: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11332 #+function: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11333 #+lob: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11334 @end example
11335
11336 @table @code
11337 @item <name>
11338 The name of the code block to be evaluated.
11339 @item <arguments>
11340 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block.
11341 @item <header arguments>
11342 Header arguments can be placed after the function invocation. See
11343 @ref{Header arguments} for more information on header arguments.
11344 @end table
11345
11346
11347 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
11348 @section Library of Babel
11349 @cindex babel, library of
11350 @cindex source code, library
11351 @cindex code block, library
11352
11353 The ``Library of Babel'' is a library of code blocks
11354 that can be called from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an
11355 Org-mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org-mode.
11356 Org-mode users can deposit functions they believe to be generally
11357 useful in the library.
11358
11359 Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called remotely as if
11360 they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}
11361 for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
11362
11363 @kindex C-c C-v i
11364 Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
11365 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
11366 i}.
11367
11368 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
11369 @section Languages
11370 @cindex babel, languages
11371 @cindex source code, languages
11372 @cindex code block, languages
11373
11374 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
11375
11376 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
11377 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
11378 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab C @tab C
11379 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
11380 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
11381 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
11382 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
11383 @item LaTeX @tab latex @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
11384 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
11385 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Oz @tab oz
11386 @item Perl @tab perl @tab Python @tab python
11387 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
11388 @item Sass @tab sass @tab GNU Screen @tab screen
11389 @item shell @tab sh @tab SQL @tab sql
11390 @item SQLite @tab sqlite
11391 @end multitable
11392
11393 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
11394 available, it can be found at
11395 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
11396
11397 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
11398 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
11399 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
11400 to your emacs configuration.
11401
11402 @quotation
11403 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
11404 @code{R} code blocks.
11405 @end quotation
11406
11407 @lisp
11408 (org-babel-do-load-languages
11409 'org-babel-load-languages
11410 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
11411 (R . t)))
11412 @end lisp
11413
11414 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
11415 elisp file with @code{require}.
11416
11417 @quotation
11418 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
11419 @end quotation
11420
11421 @lisp
11422 (require 'ob-clojure)
11423 @end lisp
11424
11425 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
11426 @section Header arguments
11427 @cindex code block, header arguments
11428 @cindex source code, block header arguments
11429
11430 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
11431 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
11432 describes each header argument in detail.
11433
11434 @menu
11435 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
11436 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
11437 @end menu
11438
11439 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
11440 @subsection Using header arguments
11441
11442 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
11443 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
11444 @menu
11445 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
11446 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
11447 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
11448 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
11449 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
11450 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
11451 @end menu
11452
11453
11454 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
11455 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
11456 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11457 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
11458 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
11459
11460 @example
11461 :session => "none"
11462 :results => "replace"
11463 :exports => "code"
11464 :cache => "no"
11465 :noweb => "no"
11466 @end example
11467
11468 @c @example
11469 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
11470 @c Its value is
11471 @c ((:session . "none")
11472 @c (:results . "replace")
11473 @c (:exports . "code")
11474 @c (:cache . "no")
11475 @c (:noweb . "no"))
11476
11477
11478 @c Documentation:
11479 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
11480 @c @end example
11481
11482 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
11483 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
11484 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
11485 blocks.
11486
11487 @lisp
11488 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
11489 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
11490 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
11491 @end lisp
11492
11493 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11494 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
11495 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
11496 language-specific documentation available online at
11497 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
11498
11499 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11500 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
11501 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a special
11502 line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of the
11503 @code{#+BABEL:} keyword followed by a series of header arguments which may be
11504 specified using the standard header argument syntax.
11505
11506 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
11507 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
11508 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
11509 inserted into the buffer.
11510
11511 @example
11512 #+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
11513 @end example
11514
11515 @node Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11516 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org-mode properties
11517
11518 Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see @ref{Property
11519 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
11520 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
11521
11522 @example
11523 #+property: tangle yes
11524 @end example
11525
11526 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
11527 with inheritance, so the value of the @code{:cache} header argument will default
11528 to @code{yes} in all code blocks in the subtree rooted at the following
11529 heading:
11530
11531 @example
11532 * outline header
11533 :PROPERTIES:
11534 :cache: yes
11535 :END:
11536 @end example
11537
11538 @kindex C-c C-x p
11539 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11540 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
11541 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
11542 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
11543 in Org-mode documents.
11544
11545 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Using header arguments
11546 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
11547
11548 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
11549 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
11550 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+begin_src} line.
11551 Properties set in this way override both the values of
11552 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
11553 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
11554 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
11555 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
11556 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
11557 preserved on export to HTML or LaTeX.
11558
11559 @example
11560 #+source: factorial
11561 #+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
11562 fac 0 = 1
11563 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
11564 #+end_src
11565 @end example
11566 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks:
11567
11568 @example
11569 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
11570 @end example
11571
11572 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11573 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11574 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
11575
11576 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
11577 function call lines can be set as shown below:
11578
11579 @example
11580 #+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
11581 @end example
11582
11583 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
11584 @subsection Specific header arguments
11585 The following header arguments are defined:
11586
11587 @menu
11588 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
11589 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
11590 be collected and handled
11591 * file:: Specify a path for file output
11592 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
11593 directory for code block execution
11594 * exports:: Export code and/or results
11595 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
11596 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
11597 code files
11598 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
11599 expansion during tangling
11600 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
11601 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
11602 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
11603 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
11604 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
11605 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
11606 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
11607 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
11608 @end menu
11609
11610 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
11611 @subsubsection @code{:var}
11612 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
11613 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
11614 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
11615 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. The
11616 values passed to arguments can be literal values, values from org-mode tables
11617 and literal example blocks, or the results of other code blocks.
11618
11619 These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays---see the
11620 ``indexable variable values'' heading below.
11621
11622 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
11623 @code{:var} header argument.
11624
11625 @example
11626 :var name=assign
11627 @end example
11628
11629 where @code{assign} can take one of the following forms
11630
11631 @itemize @bullet
11632 @item literal value
11633 either a string @code{"string"} or a number @code{9}.
11634 @item reference
11635 a table name:
11636
11637 @example
11638 #+tblname: example-table
11639 | 1 |
11640 | 2 |
11641 | 3 |
11642 | 4 |
11643
11644 #+source: table-length
11645 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
11646 (length table)
11647 #+end_src
11648
11649 #+results: table-length
11650 : 4
11651 @end example
11652
11653 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+srcname:}, followed by
11654 parentheses:
11655
11656 @example
11657 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
11658 (* 2 length)
11659 #+end_src
11660
11661 #+results:
11662 : 8
11663 @end example
11664
11665 In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
11666 by @code{:var}. The argument is passed within the parentheses following the
11667 code block name:
11668
11669 @example
11670 #+source: double
11671 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
11672 (* 2 input)
11673 #+end_src
11674
11675 #+results: double
11676 : 16
11677
11678 #+source: squared
11679 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
11680 (* input input)
11681 #+end_src
11682
11683 #+results: squared
11684 : 4
11685 @end example
11686 @end itemize
11687
11688 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
11689 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
11690 using the @code{#+source:} line of a code block. As in the following
11691 example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by commas,
11692 following the source name.
11693
11694 @example
11695 #+source: double(input=0, x=2)
11696 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11697 (* 2 (+ input x))
11698 #+end_src
11699 @end example
11700
11701 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
11702 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
11703 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
11704 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
11705 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. The
11706 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
11707 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
11708
11709 @example
11710 #+results: example-table
11711 | 1 | a |
11712 | 2 | b |
11713 | 3 | c |
11714 | 4 | d |
11715
11716 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
11717 data
11718 #+end_src
11719
11720 #+results:
11721 : a
11722 @end example
11723
11724 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
11725 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
11726 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
11727 to @code{data}.
11728
11729 @example
11730 #+results: example-table
11731 | 1 | a |
11732 | 2 | b |
11733 | 3 | c |
11734 | 4 | d |
11735 | 5 | 3 |
11736
11737 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
11738 data
11739 #+end_src
11740
11741 #+results:
11742 | 2 | b |
11743 | 3 | c |
11744 | 4 | d |
11745 @end example
11746
11747 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
11748 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
11749 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
11750 column is referenced.
11751
11752 @example
11753 #+results: example-table
11754 | 1 | a |
11755 | 2 | b |
11756 | 3 | c |
11757 | 4 | d |
11758
11759 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
11760 data
11761 #+end_src
11762
11763 #+results:
11764 | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
11765 @end example
11766
11767 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
11768 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
11769 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
11770
11771 @example
11772 #+source: 3D
11773 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11774 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
11775 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
11776 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
11777 #+end_src
11778
11779 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
11780 data
11781 #+end_src
11782
11783 #+results:
11784 | 11 | 14 | 17 |
11785 @end example
11786
11787 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
11788 @subsubsection @code{:results}
11789
11790 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
11791 per class may be supplied per code block.
11792
11793 @itemize @bullet
11794 @item
11795 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
11796 from the code block
11797 @item
11798 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
11799 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
11800 Org-mode buffer
11801 @item
11802 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
11803 block should be handled.
11804 @end itemize
11805
11806 @subsubheading Collection
11807 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
11808 should be collected from the code block.
11809
11810 @itemize @bullet
11811 @item @code{value}
11812 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
11813 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
11814 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
11815 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
11816 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
11817 @item @code{output}
11818 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
11819 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
11820 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
11821 @end itemize
11822
11823 @subsubheading Type
11824
11825 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
11826 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
11827 table or scalar depending on their value.
11828
11829 @itemize @bullet
11830 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
11831 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode table. If a single value is
11832 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
11833 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
11834 @item @code{list}
11835 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode list. If a single scalar
11836 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
11837 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
11838 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
11839 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org-mode
11840 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
11841 @item @code{file}
11842 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
11843 into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
11844 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
11845 The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and are inserted directly
11846 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
11847 such by Org-mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
11848 @item @code{html}
11849 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
11850 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
11851 @item @code{latex}
11852 Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
11853 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
11854 @item @code{code}
11855 Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in a code block.
11856 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
11857 @item @code{pp}
11858 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
11859 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
11860 @code{:results value pp}.
11861 @end itemize
11862
11863 @subsubheading Handling
11864 The following results options indicate what happens with the
11865 results once they are collected.
11866
11867 @itemize @bullet
11868 @item @code{silent}
11869 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
11870 the Org-mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
11871 @item @code{replace}
11872 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
11873 will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
11874 @code{:results output replace}.
11875 @item @code{append}
11876 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11877 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11878 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11879 @item @code{prepend}
11880 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
11881 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
11882 inserted as with @code{replace}.
11883 @end itemize
11884
11885 @node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
11886 @subsubsection @code{:file}
11887
11888 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify a path for file output.
11889 An Org-mode style @code{file:} link is inserted into the buffer as the result
11890 (see @ref{Link format}). Common examples are graphical output from R,
11891 gnuplot, ditaa and LaTeX code blocks.
11892
11893 Note that for some languages, including R, gnuplot, LaTeX and ditaa,
11894 graphical output is sent to the specified file without the file being
11895 referenced explicitly in the code block. See the documentation for the
11896 individual languages for details. In contrast, general purpose languages such
11897 as Python and Ruby require that the code explicitly create output
11898 corresponding to the path indicated by @code{:file}.
11899
11900
11901 @node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
11902 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
11903
11904 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
11905 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
11906 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
11907 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
11908 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
11909 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
11910 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
11911
11912 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
11913 (e.g. @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
11914 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
11915
11916 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
11917 in your home directory, you could use
11918
11919 @example
11920 #+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
11921 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
11922 #+end_src
11923 @end example
11924
11925 @subsubheading Remote execution
11926 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
11927 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
11928
11929 @example
11930 #+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
11931 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
11932 #+end_src
11933 @end example
11934
11935 Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual, and file
11936 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
11937 relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to the remote file will be
11938 created.
11939
11940 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
11941 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
11942
11943 @example
11944 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
11945 @end example
11946
11947 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
11948 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
11949 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
11950 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
11951
11952 @subsubheading Further points
11953
11954 @itemize @bullet
11955 @item
11956 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
11957 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
11958 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
11959 @item
11960 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
11961 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
11962 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
11963 links inserted into the buffer will *not* be expanded against @code{default
11964 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
11965 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
11966 which the link does not point.
11967 @end itemize
11968
11969 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
11970 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
11971
11972 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
11973 or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
11974
11975 @itemize @bullet
11976 @item @code{code}
11977 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
11978 @code{:exports code}.
11979 @item @code{results}
11980 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
11981 @code{:exports results}.
11982 @item @code{both}
11983 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
11984 @code{:exports both}.
11985 @item @code{none}
11986 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
11987 @end itemize
11988
11989 @node tangle, comments, exports, Specific header arguments
11990 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
11991
11992 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
11993 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
11994
11995 @itemize @bullet
11996 @item @code{tangle}
11997 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the
11998 basename (name w/o extension) of the Org-mode file. E.g., @code{:tangle
11999 yes}.
12000 @item @code{no}
12001 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
12002 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
12003 @item other
12004 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
12005 as a file basename to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle
12006 basename}.
12007 @end itemize
12008
12009 @node comments, no-expand, tangle, Specific header arguments
12010 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
12011 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
12012 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
12013 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
12014 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
12015
12016 @itemize @bullet
12017 @item @code{no}
12018 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
12019 @item @code{link}
12020 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
12021 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
12022 @item @code{yes}
12023 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
12024 @item @code{org}
12025 Include text from the org-mode file as a comment.
12026
12027 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
12028 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
12029 @item @code{both}
12030 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
12031 @end itemize
12032
12033 @node no-expand, session, comments, Specific header arguments
12034 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
12035
12036 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
12037 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
12038 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
12039 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
12040 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
12041
12042 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
12043 @subsubsection @code{:session}
12044
12045 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
12046 language where state is preserved.
12047
12048 By default, a session is not started.
12049
12050 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
12051 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
12052 interpreted language.
12053
12054 @node noweb, cache, session, Specific header arguments
12055 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
12056
12057 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
12058 @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
12059 argument can have one of three values: @code{yes} @code{no} or @code{tangle}.
12060
12061 @itemize @bullet
12062 @item @code{yes}
12063 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
12064 expanded before the block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
12065 @item @code{no}
12066 The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken on evaluating
12067 code blocks, However, noweb references will still be expanded during
12068 tangling.
12069 @item @code{tangle}
12070 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
12071 expanded before the block is tangled, however ``noweb'' references will not
12072 be expanded when the block is evaluated or exported.
12073 @end itemize
12074
12075 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
12076 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
12077 @code{<<reference>>}.
12078 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
12079 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
12080 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
12081
12082 This code block:
12083
12084 @example
12085 -- <<example>>
12086 @end example
12087
12088
12089 expands to:
12090
12091 @example
12092 -- this is the
12093 -- multi-line body of example
12094 @end example
12095
12096 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
12097 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
12098 references.
12099
12100 @node cache, hlines, noweb, Specific header arguments
12101 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
12102
12103 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
12104 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
12105 unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one of two
12106 values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
12107
12108 @itemize @bullet
12109 @item @code{no}
12110 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
12111 every time it is called.
12112 @item @code{yes}
12113 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
12114 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
12115 @code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
12116 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
12117 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
12118 @end itemize
12119
12120 @node hlines, colnames, cache, Specific header arguments
12121 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
12122
12123 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
12124 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
12125 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12126
12127 @itemize @bullet
12128 @item @code{no}
12129 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
12130 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
12131 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
12132 default value yields the following results.
12133
12134 @example
12135 #+tblname: many-cols
12136 | a | b | c |
12137 |---+---+---|
12138 | d | e | f |
12139 |---+---+---|
12140 | g | h | i |
12141
12142 #+source: echo-table
12143 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
12144 return tab
12145 #+end_src
12146
12147 #+results: echo-table
12148 | a | b | c |
12149 | d | e | f |
12150 | g | h | i |
12151 @end example
12152
12153 @item @code{yes}
12154 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
12155
12156 @example
12157 #+tblname: many-cols
12158 | a | b | c |
12159 |---+---+---|
12160 | d | e | f |
12161 |---+---+---|
12162 | g | h | i |
12163
12164 #+source: echo-table
12165 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
12166 return tab
12167 #+end_src
12168
12169 #+results: echo-table
12170 | a | b | c |
12171 |---+---+---|
12172 | d | e | f |
12173 |---+---+---|
12174 | g | h | i |
12175 @end example
12176 @end itemize
12177
12178 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
12179 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
12180
12181 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
12182 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
12183
12184 @itemize @bullet
12185 @item @code{nil}
12186 If an input table looks like it has column names
12187 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
12188 names will be removed from the table before
12189 processing, then reapplied to the results.
12190
12191 @example
12192 #+tblname: less-cols
12193 | a |
12194 |---|
12195 | b |
12196 | c |
12197
12198 #+srcname: echo-table-again
12199 #+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
12200 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
12201 #+end_src
12202
12203 #+results: echo-table-again
12204 | a |
12205 |----|
12206 | b* |
12207 | c* |
12208 @end example
12209
12210 @item @code{no}
12211 No column name pre-processing takes place
12212
12213 @item @code{yes}
12214 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
12215 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e. the second row is not an
12216 hline)
12217 @end itemize
12218
12219 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
12220 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
12221
12222 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
12223 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12224
12225 @itemize @bullet
12226 @item @code{no}
12227 No row name pre-processing will take place.
12228
12229 @item @code{yes}
12230 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
12231 and is then reapplied to the results.
12232
12233 @example
12234 #+tblname: with-rownames
12235 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
12236 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
12237
12238 #+srcname: echo-table-once-again
12239 #+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
12240 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
12241 #+end_src
12242
12243 #+results: echo-table-once-again
12244 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
12245 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
12246 @end example
12247 @end itemize
12248
12249 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
12250 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
12251
12252 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
12253 (e.g. @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
12254 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
12255 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
12256
12257 @node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
12258 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
12259 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
12260 specific code blocks. @code{:eval} accepts two arguments ``never'' and
12261 ``query''. @code{:eval never} will ensure that a code block is never
12262 evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
12263 dangerous code blocks. @code{:eval query} will require a query for every
12264 execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
12265 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable.
12266
12267 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
12268 @section Results of evaluation
12269 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
12270 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
12271
12272 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
12273 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
12274 used. The following table shows the possibilities:
12275
12276 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
12277 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
12278 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
12279 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
12280 @end multitable
12281
12282 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
12283 non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
12284 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
12285
12286 @subsection Non-session
12287 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12288 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
12289 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
12290 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
12291 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
12292 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
12293 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
12294
12295 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
12296 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
12297
12298 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12299 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
12300 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
12301 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
12302 future work.)
12303
12304 @subsection Session
12305 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12306 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12307 inferior process. The result returned is the result of the last evaluation
12308 performed by the interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific
12309 manner: the value of the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value
12310 of @code{.Last.value} in R).
12311
12312 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12313 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12314 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
12315 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
12316 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
12317 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
12318 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
12319
12320 @example
12321 #+begin_src python :results output
12322 print "hello"
12323 2
12324 print "bye"
12325 #+end_src
12326
12327 #+resname:
12328 : hello
12329 : bye
12330 @end example
12331
12332 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
12333 @example
12334 #+begin_src python :results output :session
12335 print "hello"
12336 2
12337 print "bye"
12338 #+end_src
12339
12340 #+resname:
12341 : hello
12342 : 2
12343 : bye
12344 @end example
12345
12346 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
12347 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
12348 unnecessary here).
12349
12350 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
12351 @section Noweb reference syntax
12352 @cindex code block, noweb reference
12353 @cindex syntax, noweb
12354 @cindex source code, noweb reference
12355
12356 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
12357 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
12358 familiar Noweb syntax:
12359
12360 @example
12361 <<code-block-name>>
12362 @end example
12363
12364 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
12365 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
12366 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
12367 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
12368 expanded before evaluation.
12369
12370 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
12371 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
12372 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
12373 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
12374 the default value.
12375
12376 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
12377 @section Key bindings and useful functions
12378 @cindex code block, key bindings
12379
12380 Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
12381 the context.
12382
12383 Within a code block, the following key bindings
12384 are active:
12385
12386 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12387 @kindex C-c C-c
12388 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab org-babel-execute-src-block
12389 @kindex C-c C-o
12390 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab org-babel-open-src-block-result
12391 @kindex C-up
12392 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab org-babel-load-in-session
12393 @kindex M-down
12394 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab org-babel-pop-to-session
12395 @end multitable
12396
12397 In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
12398
12399 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
12400 @kindex C-c C-v a
12401 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
12402 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12403 @kindex C-c C-v b
12404 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
12405 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12406 @kindex C-c C-v f
12407 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
12408 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12409 @kindex C-c C-v g
12410 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @tab org-babel-goto-named-source-block
12411 @kindex C-c C-v h
12412 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @tab org-babel-describe-bindings
12413 @kindex C-c C-v l
12414 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
12415 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12416 @kindex C-c C-v p
12417 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
12418 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12419 @kindex C-c C-v s
12420 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
12421 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12422 @kindex C-c C-v t
12423 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
12424 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12425 @kindex C-c C-v z
12426 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
12427 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12428 @end multitable
12429
12430 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
12431 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
12432
12433 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12434 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
12435 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
12436 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
12437 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
12438 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
12439 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
12440 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
12441 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
12442 @c @end multitable
12443
12444 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
12445 @section Batch execution
12446 @cindex code block, batch execution
12447 @cindex source code, batch execution
12448
12449 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
12450 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
12451
12452 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
12453
12454 @example
12455 #!/bin/sh
12456 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
12457 #
12458 # tangle files with org-mode
12459 #
12460 DIR=`pwd`
12461 FILES=""
12462 ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
12463
12464 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
12465 for i in $@@; do
12466 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
12467 done
12468
12469 emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
12470 --eval "(progn
12471 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
12472 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
12473 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
12474 (mapc (lambda (file)
12475 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
12476 (org-babel-tangle)
12477 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
12478 @end example
12479
12480 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
12481 @chapter Miscellaneous
12482
12483 @menu
12484 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
12485 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
12486 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
12487 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
12488 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
12489 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
12490 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
12491 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
12492 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
12493 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
12494 @end menu
12495
12496
12497 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
12498 @section Completion
12499 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
12500 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
12501 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
12502 @cindex completion, of option keywords
12503 @cindex completion, of tags
12504 @cindex completion, of property keys
12505 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
12506 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
12507 @cindex TODO keywords completion
12508 @cindex dictionary word completion
12509 @cindex option keyword completion
12510 @cindex tag completion
12511 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
12512
12513 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
12514 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
12515 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
12516 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
12517 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
12518
12519 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
12520 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
12521 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
12522
12523 @table @kbd
12524 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
12525 @item M-@key{TAB}
12526 Complete word at point
12527 @itemize @bullet
12528 @item
12529 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
12530 @item
12531 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
12532 @item
12533 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
12534 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
12535 @item
12536 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
12537 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
12538 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
12539 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
12540 @item
12541 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
12542 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
12543 buffer.
12544 @item
12545 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
12546 @item
12547 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
12548 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the
12549 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
12550 will insert example settings for this keyword.
12551 @item
12552 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
12553 i.e. valid keys for this line.
12554 @item
12555 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
12556 @end itemize
12557 @end table
12558
12559 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
12560 @section Easy Templates
12561 @cindex template insertion
12562 @cindex insertion, of templates
12563
12564 Org-mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
12565 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
12566 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
12567 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
12568 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
12569
12570 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
12571 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
12572 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
12573
12574 The following template selectors are currently supported.
12575
12576 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
12577 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+begin_src ... #+end_src}
12578 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+begin_example ... #+end_example}
12579 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+begin_quote ... #+end_quote}
12580 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+begin_verse ... #+end_verse}
12581 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+begin_center ... #+end_center}
12582 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+begin_latex ... #+end_latex}
12583 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+latex:}
12584 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+begin_html ... #+end_html}
12585 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+html:}
12586 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+begin_ascii ... #+end_ascii}
12587 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ascii:}
12588 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+include:} line
12589 @end multitable
12590
12591 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
12592 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
12593
12594 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
12595 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
12596 additional details.
12597
12598 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
12599 @section Speed keys
12600 @cindex speed keys
12601 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
12602 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
12603
12604 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
12605 beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the variable
12606 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
12607 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
12608 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
12609 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
12610 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
12611 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
12612
12613 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
12614 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
12615
12616 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
12617 @section Code evaluation and security issues
12618
12619 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
12620
12621 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
12622 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
12623 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
12624 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
12625 these precautions intact.
12626
12627 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
12628 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
12629 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
12630
12631 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
12632
12633 @table @i
12634 @item Source code blocks
12635 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
12636 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
12637 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
12638 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
12639 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
12640
12641 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
12642 which take off the default security brakes.
12643
12644 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
12645 When set to t user is queried before code block evaluation
12646 @end defopt
12647
12648 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
12649 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
12650 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
12651 not visible.
12652
12653 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
12654 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
12655 @end defopt
12656 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
12657 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
12658 @end defopt
12659
12660 @item Formulas in tables
12661 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
12662 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
12663 @end table
12664
12665 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
12666 @section Customization
12667 @cindex customization
12668 @cindex options, for customization
12669 @cindex variables, for customization
12670
12671 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
12672 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
12673 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
12674 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
12675 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
12676 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
12677 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
12678
12679 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
12680 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
12681 @cindex in-buffer settings
12682 @cindex special keywords
12683
12684 Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
12685 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
12686 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
12687 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
12688 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
12689 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
12690 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
12691 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
12692 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
12693
12694 @vindex org-archive-location
12695 @table @kbd
12696 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
12697 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
12698 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
12699 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12700 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
12701 @item #+CATEGORY:
12702 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
12703 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
12704 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12705 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
12706 @cindex property, COLUMNS
12707 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
12708 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
12709 applies.
12710 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
12711 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
12712 @vindex org-table-formula
12713 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
12714 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
12715 The global version of this variable is
12716 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
12717 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
12718 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
12719 top-level entries.
12720 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
12721 @vindex org-drawers
12722 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
12723 @code{org-drawers}.
12724 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
12725 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
12726 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
12727 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
12728 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
12729 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
12730 @vindex org-highest-priority
12731 @vindex org-lowest-priority
12732 @vindex org-default-priority
12733 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
12734 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
12735 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
12736 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
12737 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
12738 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
12739 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
12740 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
12741 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
12742 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
12743 (i.e. when starting Org-mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
12744 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
12745 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
12746 any other Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
12747 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
12748 @item #+STARTUP:
12749 @cindex #+STARTUP:
12750 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
12751 Org file is being visited.
12752
12753 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
12754 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
12755 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
12756 @code{overview}.
12757 @vindex org-startup-folded
12758 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
12759 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
12760 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
12761 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
12762 @example
12763 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
12764 content @r{all headlines}
12765 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
12766 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
12767 @end example
12768
12769 @vindex org-startup-indented
12770 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
12771 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
12772 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
12773 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
12774 @example
12775 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
12776 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
12777 @end example
12778
12779 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
12780 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
12781 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
12782 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
12783 @code{nil}.
12784 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
12785 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
12786 @example
12787 align @r{align all tables}
12788 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
12789 @end example
12790
12791 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
12792 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
12793 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
12794 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
12795 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
12796 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
12797 @example
12798 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
12799 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
12800 @end example
12801
12802 @vindex org-log-done
12803 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
12804 @vindex org-log-repeat
12805 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
12806 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
12807 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
12808 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
12809 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
12810 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
12811 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12812 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
12813 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12814 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12815 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
12816 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12817 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12818 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
12819 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12820 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12821 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
12822 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12823 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
12824 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
12825 @example
12826 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
12827 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
12828 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
12829 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
12830 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
12831 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
12832 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
12833 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
12834 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
12835 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
12836 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
12837 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
12838 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
12839 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
12840 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
12841 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
12842 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
12843 @end example
12844 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
12845 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
12846 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
12847 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
12848 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
12849 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
12850 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
12851 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
12852 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
12853 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
12854 @example
12855 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
12856 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
12857 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
12858 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
12859 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
12860 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
12861 @end example
12862 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
12863 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
12864 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
12865 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
12866 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
12867 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
12868 @example
12869 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
12870 @end example
12871 @vindex constants-unit-system
12872 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
12873 @code{constants-unit-system}).
12874 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
12875 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
12876 @example
12877 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
12878 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
12879 @end example
12880 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
12881 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
12882 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
12883 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
12884 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
12885 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
12886 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
12887 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
12888 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
12889 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
12890 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
12891 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
12892 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
12893 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12894 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
12895 @example
12896 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
12897 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
12898 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
12899 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
12900 fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
12901 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
12902 fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
12903 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
12904 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
12905 @end example
12906 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
12907 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
12908 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
12909 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12910 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
12911 @example
12912 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
12913 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
12914 @end example
12915 @cindex org-pretty-entities
12916 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
12917 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
12918 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
12919 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
12920 @example
12921 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
12922 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
12923 @end example
12924 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
12925 @vindex org-tag-alist
12926 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
12927 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
12928 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
12929 @item #+TBLFM:
12930 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
12931 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
12932 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
12933 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
12934 @itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
12935 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
12936 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
12937 @ref{Export options}.
12938 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
12939 @vindex org-todo-keywords
12940 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
12941 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
12942 @end table
12943
12944 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
12945 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
12946 @kindex C-c C-c
12947 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
12948
12949 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
12950 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
12951 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
12952 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
12953 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
12954 what this means in different contexts.
12955
12956 @itemize @minus
12957 @item
12958 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
12959 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
12960 @item
12961 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
12962 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
12963 information.
12964 @item
12965 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
12966 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
12967 @item
12968 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
12969 the entire table.
12970 @item
12971 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
12972 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
12973 default location.
12974 @item
12975 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
12976 corresponding links in this buffer.
12977 @item
12978 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
12979 drawer, offer property commands.
12980 @item
12981 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
12982 definition, and vice versa.
12983 @item
12984 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
12985 @item
12986 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
12987 of the checkbox.
12988 @item
12989 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
12990 ordered list.
12991 @item
12992 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
12993 block is updated.
12994 @end itemize
12995
12996 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
12997 @section A cleaner outline view
12998 @cindex hiding leading stars
12999 @cindex dynamic indentation
13000 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
13001 @cindex clean outline view
13002
13003 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
13004 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
13005 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
13006 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
13007 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
13008
13009 @example
13010 @group
13011 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
13012 ** Second level | * Second level
13013 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
13014 some text | some text
13015 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
13016 more text | more text
13017 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
13018 @end group
13019 @end example
13020
13021 @noindent
13022
13023 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
13024 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
13025 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
13026 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
13027 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
13028 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
13029 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
13030 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
13031 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
13032 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
13033 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
13034 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
13035 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
13036 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
13037 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
13038 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
13039 individual files using
13040
13041 @example
13042 #+STARTUP: indent
13043 @end example
13044
13045 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
13046 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
13047 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
13048 the following way:
13049
13050 @enumerate
13051 @item
13052 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
13053 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
13054 with the headline, like
13055
13056 @example
13057 *** 3rd level
13058 more text, now indented
13059 @end example
13060
13061 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
13062 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
13063 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
13064 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
13065
13066 @item
13067 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
13068 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
13069 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
13070 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
13071 with
13072
13073 @example
13074 #+STARTUP: hidestars
13075 #+STARTUP: showstars
13076 @end example
13077
13078 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
13079
13080 @example
13081 @group
13082 * Top level headline
13083 * Second level
13084 * 3rd level
13085 ...
13086 @end group
13087 @end example
13088
13089 @noindent
13090 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
13091 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
13092 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
13093 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
13094 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
13095 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
13096 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
13097
13098 @item
13099 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13100 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
13101 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
13102 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
13103 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
13104 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
13105 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
13106 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
13107 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
13108
13109 @example
13110 #+STARTUP: odd
13111 #+STARTUP: oddeven
13112 @end example
13113
13114 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
13115 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
13116 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
13117 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
13118 @end enumerate
13119
13120 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
13121 @section Using Org on a tty
13122 @cindex tty key bindings
13123
13124 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
13125 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
13126 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
13127 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
13128 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
13129 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
13130 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
13131 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
13132 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
13133 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
13134 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
13135
13136 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
13137 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
13138 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
13139 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
13140 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
13141 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
13142 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
13143 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
13144 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
13145 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
13146 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
13147 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13148 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
13149 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13150 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13151 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13152 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13153 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13154 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13155 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13156 @end multitable
13157
13158
13159 @node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
13160 @section Interaction with other packages
13161 @cindex packages, interaction with other
13162 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
13163 with other code out there.
13164
13165 @menu
13166 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
13167 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
13168 @end menu
13169
13170 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
13171 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
13172
13173 @table @asis
13174 @cindex @file{calc.el}
13175 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
13176 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
13177 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
13178 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
13179 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
13180 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
13181 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
13182 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
13183 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
13184 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
13185 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
13186 @cindex @file{constants.el}
13187 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13188 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
13189 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
13190 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
13191 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
13192 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
13193 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
13194 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
13195 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
13196 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
13197 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
13198 @file{constants.el}.
13199 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
13200 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
13201 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13202 Org-mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
13203 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
13204 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
13205 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
13206 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
13207 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
13208 @lisp
13209 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13210 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
13211 @end lisp
13212 @vindex org-imenu-depth
13213 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
13214 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
13215 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
13216 @cindex @file{remember.el}
13217 @cindex Wiegley, John
13218 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
13219 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
13220 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
13221 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
13222 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
13223 index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
13224 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
13225 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
13226 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
13227 @cindex @file{table.el}
13228 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
13229 @kindex C-c C-c
13230 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
13231 @cindex @file{table.el}
13232 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
13233
13234 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
13235 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
13236 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
13237 Org-mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
13238 interference with other Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
13239 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
13240 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
13241
13242 @table @kbd
13243 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
13244 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
13245 @c
13246 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
13247 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
13248 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
13249 format. See the documentation string of the command
13250 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
13251 possible.
13252 @end table
13253 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
13254 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
13255 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
13256 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
13257 Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
13258 However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
13259 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
13260 @end table
13261
13262 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
13263 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
13264
13265 @table @asis
13266
13267 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
13268 @vindex org-support-shift-select
13269 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
13270 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
13271 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
13272 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
13273 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
13274 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
13275 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
13276 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
13277 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
13278 cursor moves across a special context.
13279
13280 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
13281 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
13282 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
13283 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
13284 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
13285 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
13286 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
13287 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
13288 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
13289 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
13290 Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
13291 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
13292 buffer (but not during date selection).
13293
13294 @example
13295 S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
13296 S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
13297 C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
13298 @end example
13299
13300 @vindex org-disputed-keys
13301 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
13302 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
13303 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
13304
13305 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
13306 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
13307 The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
13308 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
13309 fixed this problem:
13310
13311 @lisp
13312 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13313 (lambda ()
13314 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
13315 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
13316 @end lisp
13317
13318 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
13319 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
13320 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
13321 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
13322 the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode does not have
13323 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
13324 configuration:
13325
13326 @lisp
13327 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
13328 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
13329 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
13330 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
13331 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
13332 @end lisp
13333
13334 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
13335 @cindex @file{viper.el}
13336 @kindex C-c /
13337 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
13338 corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
13339 another key for this command, or override the key in
13340 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
13341
13342 @lisp
13343 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
13344 @end lisp
13345
13346 @end table
13347
13348
13349 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
13350 @appendix Hacking
13351 @cindex hacking
13352
13353 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
13354 Org.
13355
13356 @menu
13357 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
13358 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
13359 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
13360 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
13361 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
13362 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
13363 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
13364 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
13365 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
13366 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
13367 @end menu
13368
13369 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
13370 @section Hooks
13371 @cindex hooks
13372
13373 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
13374 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
13375 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
13376 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
13377 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
13378
13379 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
13380 @section Add-on packages
13381 @cindex add-on packages
13382
13383 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
13384 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
13385 packages with the separate release available at the Org-mode home page at
13386 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
13387 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
13388 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
13389
13390
13391
13392 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
13393 @section Adding hyperlink types
13394 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
13395
13396 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
13397 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
13398 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
13399 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
13400 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
13401 Emacs:
13402
13403 @lisp
13404 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
13405
13406 (require 'org)
13407
13408 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
13409 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
13410
13411 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
13412 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
13413 :group 'org-link
13414 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
13415
13416 (defun org-man-open (path)
13417 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
13418 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
13419 (funcall org-man-command path))
13420
13421 (defun org-man-store-link ()
13422 "Store a link to a manpage."
13423 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
13424 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
13425 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
13426 (link (concat "man:" page))
13427 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
13428 (org-store-link-props
13429 :type "man"
13430 :link link
13431 :description description))))
13432
13433 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
13434 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
13435 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
13436 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
13437 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
13438 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
13439
13440 (provide 'org-man)
13441
13442 ;;; org-man.el ends here
13443 @end lisp
13444
13445 @noindent
13446 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
13447
13448 @lisp
13449 (require 'org-man)
13450 @end lisp
13451
13452 @noindent
13453 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
13454 @enumerate
13455 @item
13456 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
13457 loaded.
13458 @item
13459 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
13460 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
13461 that will be called to follow such a link.
13462 @item
13463 @vindex org-store-link-functions
13464 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
13465 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
13466 buffer displaying a man page.
13467 @end enumerate
13468
13469 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
13470 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
13471 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
13472 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
13473 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
13474 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
13475 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
13476
13477 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
13478 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
13479 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
13480 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
13481 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
13482 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
13483 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
13484 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
13485 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
13486 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
13487 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
13488 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
13489
13490 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
13491 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
13492 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
13493 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
13494
13495 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
13496 @section Context-sensitive commands
13497 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
13498 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
13499 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
13500
13501 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
13502 important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
13503 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
13504
13505 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
13506 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
13507 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
13508 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
13509 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the org-mode functionality
13510 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
13511 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
13512 @code{#+RR:}.
13513
13514 @lisp
13515 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
13516 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
13517 (if (save-excursion
13518 (beginning-of-line 1)
13519 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
13520 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
13521 t) ;; to signal that we took action
13522 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
13523
13524 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
13525 @end lisp
13526
13527 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
13528 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
13529 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
13530 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
13531
13532
13533 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
13534 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
13535 @cindex tables, in other modes
13536 @cindex lists, in other modes
13537 @cindex Orgtbl mode
13538
13539 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
13540 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
13541 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
13542 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
13543 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
13544 editor.
13545
13546 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
13547 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
13548 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
13549 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
13550 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
13551 for a very flexible system.
13552
13553 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
13554 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
13555 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
13556 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
13557
13558
13559 @menu
13560 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
13561 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
13562 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
13563 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
13564 @end menu
13565
13566 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13567 @subsection Radio tables
13568 @cindex radio tables
13569
13570 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
13571 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
13572 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
13573 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
13574
13575 @example
13576 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13577 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13578 @end example
13579
13580 @noindent
13581 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
13582 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
13583 example:
13584 @cindex #+ORGTBL
13585 @example
13586 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
13587 @end example
13588
13589 @noindent
13590 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
13591 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
13592 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
13593 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
13594 passed as a property list to the translation function for
13595 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
13596 acted upon before the translation function is called:
13597
13598 @table @code
13599 @item :skip N
13600 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
13601 this parameter!
13602
13603 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
13604 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
13605 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
13606 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
13607 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
13608 additional columns.
13609 @end table
13610
13611 @noindent
13612 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
13613 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
13614 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
13615 number of different solutions:
13616
13617 @itemize @bullet
13618 @item
13619 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
13620 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
13621 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
13622 @item
13623 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
13624 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
13625 in @LaTeX{}.
13626 @item
13627 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
13628 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
13629 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
13630 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
13631 key.
13632 @end itemize
13633
13634 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13635 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
13636 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
13637
13638 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
13639 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
13640 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
13641 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
13642 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
13643 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
13644 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
13645 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
13646 will then get the following template:
13647
13648 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
13649 @example
13650 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13651 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13652 \begin@{comment@}
13653 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13654 | | |
13655 \end@{comment@}
13656 @end example
13657
13658 @noindent
13659 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
13660 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
13661 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
13662 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
13663 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
13664 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
13665 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
13666 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
13667 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
13668 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
13669 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
13670 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
13671
13672 @example
13673 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13674 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13675 \begin@{comment@}
13676 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13677 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13678 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13679 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13680 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13681 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13682 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13683 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
13684 \end@{comment@}
13685 @end example
13686
13687 @noindent
13688 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
13689 table inserted between the two marker lines.
13690
13691 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
13692 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
13693 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
13694 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
13695 header and footer commands of the target table:
13696
13697 @example
13698 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
13699 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
13700 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13701 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13702 \end@{tabular@}
13703 %
13704 \begin@{comment@}
13705 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
13706 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13707 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13708 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13709 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13710 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13711 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13712 \end@{comment@}
13713 @end example
13714
13715 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
13716 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
13717 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
13718 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
13719
13720 @table @code
13721 @item :splice nil/t
13722 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
13723 tabular environment. Default is nil.
13724
13725 @item :fmt fmt
13726 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
13727 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
13728 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
13729 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
13730 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
13731 function must return a formatted string.
13732
13733 @item :efmt efmt
13734 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
13735 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
13736 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
13737 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
13738 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
13739 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
13740 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
13741 supplied instead of strings.
13742 @end table
13743
13744 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13745 @subsection Translator functions
13746 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
13747 @cindex translator function
13748
13749 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
13750 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
13751 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
13752 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
13753 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
13754 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
13755 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
13756 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
13757 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
13758
13759 @lisp
13760 @group
13761 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
13762 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
13763 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
13764 org-table-last-alignment ""))
13765 (params2
13766 (list
13767 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
13768 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
13769 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
13770 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
13771 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
13772 @end group
13773 @end lisp
13774
13775 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
13776 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
13777 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
13778 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
13779 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
13780 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
13781 overrule the default with
13782
13783 @example
13784 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
13785 @end example
13786
13787 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
13788 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
13789 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
13790 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
13791 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
13792 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
13793 a single line!):
13794
13795 @example
13796 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
13797 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
13798 @end example
13799
13800 @noindent
13801 Please check the documentation string of the function
13802 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
13803 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
13804 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
13805 using the generic function.
13806
13807 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
13808 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
13809 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
13810 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
13811 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
13812 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
13813 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
13814 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
13815 others can benefit from your work.
13816
13817 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13818 @subsection Radio lists
13819 @cindex radio lists
13820 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
13821
13822 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
13823 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
13824 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
13825 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
13826
13827 Here are the differences with radio tables:
13828
13829 @itemize @minus
13830 @item
13831 Orgstruct mode must be active.
13832 @item
13833 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
13834 @item
13835 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
13836 parameters.
13837 @item
13838 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
13839 @end itemize
13840
13841 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
13842 @LaTeX{} file:
13843
13844 @cindex #+ORGLST
13845 @example
13846 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13847 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
13848 \begin@{comment@}
13849 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
13850 - a new house
13851 - a new computer
13852 + a new keyboard
13853 + a new mouse
13854 - a new life
13855 \end@{comment@}
13856 @end example
13857
13858 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
13859 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
13860
13861 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
13862 @section Dynamic blocks
13863 @cindex dynamic blocks
13864
13865 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
13866 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
13867 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
13868 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
13869
13870 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
13871 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
13872 the content of the block.
13873
13874 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
13875 @example
13876 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
13877
13878 #+END:
13879 @end example
13880
13881 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
13882
13883 @table @kbd
13884 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
13885 Update dynamic block at point.
13886 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
13887 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
13888 @end table
13889
13890 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
13891 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
13892 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
13893 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
13894 extra parameter @code{:content}.
13895
13896 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
13897 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
13898 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
13899 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
13900 run:
13901
13902 @example
13903 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
13904
13905 #+END:
13906 @end example
13907
13908 @noindent
13909 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
13910
13911 @lisp
13912 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
13913 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
13914 (insert "Last block update at: "
13915 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
13916 @end lisp
13917
13918 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
13919 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
13920 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
13921 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
13922 @code{org-mode}.
13923
13924 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
13925 @section Special agenda views
13926 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
13927
13928 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
13929 made by these agenda views: @code{todo}, @code{alltodo}, @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo},
13930 @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function that is used at each match to verify
13931 if the match should indeed be part of the agenda view, and if not, how
13932 much should be skipped.
13933
13934 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
13935 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
13936 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
13937 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
13938 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
13939 the subtree belonging to the project line.
13940
13941 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
13942 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
13943 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
13944 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
13945 search should continue from there.
13946
13947 @lisp
13948 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
13949 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
13950 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
13951 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
13952 nil ; tag found, do not skip
13953 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
13954 @end lisp
13955
13956 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
13957 like this:
13958
13959 @lisp
13960 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
13961 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
13962 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
13963 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
13964 @end lisp
13965
13966 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
13967 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
13968 meaningful header in the agenda view.
13969
13970 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13971 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
13972 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
13973 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
13974 your custom search function, simply do a search for
13975 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
13976 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
13977 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
13978 you really want to have.
13979
13980 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
13981 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
13982 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
13983
13984 @table @code
13985 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
13986 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
13987 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
13988 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
13989 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
13990 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
13991 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
13992 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
13993 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
13994 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
13995 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
13996 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
13997 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
13998 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
13999 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
14000 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
14001 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
14002 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
14003 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
14004 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
14005 @end table
14006
14007 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
14008 like this, even without defining a special function:
14009
14010 @lisp
14011 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
14012 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
14013 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
14014 'regexp ":waiting:"))
14015 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
14016 @end lisp
14017
14018 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
14019 @section Extracting agenda information
14020 @cindex agenda, pipe
14021 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
14022
14023 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
14024 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
14025 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
14026 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
14027 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
14028 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
14029 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
14030 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
14031 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
14032 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
14033 current TODO list, you could use
14034
14035 @example
14036 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
14037 @end example
14038
14039 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
14040 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
14041 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
14042 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
14043
14044 @example
14045 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
14046 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
14047 @end example
14048
14049 @noindent
14050 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
14051
14052 @example
14053 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
14054 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
14055 org-agenda-span month \
14056 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
14057 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
14058 | lpr
14059 @end example
14060
14061 @noindent
14062 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
14063 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
14064
14065 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
14066 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
14067 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
14068 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
14069 are:
14070
14071 @example
14072 category @r{The category of the item}
14073 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
14074 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
14075 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
14076 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
14077 diary @r{imported from diary}
14078 deadline @r{a deadline}
14079 scheduled @r{scheduled}
14080 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
14081 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
14082 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
14083 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
14084 block @r{entry has date block including date}
14085 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
14086 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
14087 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
14088 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
14089 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
14090 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
14091 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
14092 @end example
14093
14094 @noindent
14095 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
14096 led to the selection of the item.
14097
14098 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
14099 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
14100 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
14101
14102 @example
14103 #!/usr/bin/perl
14104
14105 # define the Emacs command to run
14106 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
14107
14108 # run it and capture the output
14109 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
14110
14111 # loop over all lines
14112 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
14113 # get the individual values
14114 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
14115 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
14116 # process and print
14117 print "[ ] $head\n";
14118 @}
14119 @end example
14120
14121 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
14122 @section Using the property API
14123 @cindex API, for properties
14124 @cindex properties, API
14125
14126 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
14127 properties.
14128
14129 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
14130 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
14131 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
14132 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
14133 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
14134 if the property key was used several times.@*
14135 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
14136 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
14137 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
14138 @end defun
14139 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
14140 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
14141 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
14142 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
14143 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
14144 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
14145 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
14146 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
14147 @end defun
14148
14149 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
14150 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
14151 @end defun
14152
14153 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
14154 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
14155 @end defun
14156
14157 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
14158 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
14159 @end defun
14160
14161 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
14162 Insert a property drawer at point.
14163 @end defun
14164
14165 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
14166 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
14167 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
14168 @end defun
14169
14170 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
14171 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14172 values and return the values as a list of strings.
14173 @end defun
14174
14175 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
14176 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14177 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
14178 @end defun
14179
14180 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
14181 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14182 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
14183 @end defun
14184
14185 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
14186 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14187 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
14188 @end defun
14189
14190 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
14191 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
14192 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
14193 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
14194 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
14195 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
14196 responsible for this property.
14197 @end defopt
14198
14199 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
14200 @section Using the mapping API
14201 @cindex API, for mapping
14202 @cindex mapping entries, API
14203
14204 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
14205 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
14206 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
14207 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
14208 is:
14209
14210 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
14211 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
14212
14213 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
14214 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
14215 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
14216 returned as a list.
14217
14218 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
14219 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
14220 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
14221 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
14222 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
14223 if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current (sub)tree it could
14224 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
14225 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
14226 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
14227 position.
14228
14229 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
14230 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
14231 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
14232 visited by the iteration.
14233
14234 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
14235
14236 @example
14237 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
14238 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
14239 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
14240 file-with-archives
14241 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
14242 agenda @r{all agenda files}
14243 agenda-with-archives
14244 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
14245 (file1 file2 ...)
14246 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
14247 @end example
14248 @noindent
14249 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
14250 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
14251
14252 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14253 @example
14254 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
14255 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
14256 function or Lisp form
14257 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
14258 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
14259 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
14260 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
14261 @end example
14262 @end defun
14263
14264 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
14265 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
14266 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
14267 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
14268
14269 @defun org-todo &optional arg
14270 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
14271 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
14272 @end defun
14273
14274 @defun org-priority &optional action
14275 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
14276 possible values for ACTION.
14277 @end defun
14278
14279 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
14280 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
14281 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
14282 @end defun
14283
14284 @defun org-promote
14285 Promote the current entry.
14286 @end defun
14287
14288 @defun org-demote
14289 Demote the current entry.
14290 @end defun
14291
14292 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
14293 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
14294 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
14295
14296 @lisp
14297 (org-map-entries
14298 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
14299 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
14300 @end lisp
14301
14302 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
14303 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
14304
14305 @lisp
14306 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
14307 @end lisp
14308
14309 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
14310 @appendix MobileOrg
14311 @cindex iPhone
14312 @cindex MobileOrg
14313
14314 @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
14315 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
14316 @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
14317 system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
14318 changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
14319 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
14320 by Matt Jones.
14321
14322 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
14323 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
14324 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
14325
14326 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
14327 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
14328 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
14329 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
14330 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
14331 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
14332 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
14333
14334 @menu
14335 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
14336 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
14337 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
14338 @end menu
14339
14340 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14341 @section Setting up the staging area
14342
14343 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
14344 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
14345 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org-mode 7.02 and with
14346 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
14347 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
14348 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
14349 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
14350 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
14351 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
14352 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
14353 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
14354
14355 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
14356 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
14357 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
14358 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
14359 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.php#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
14360 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
14361 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
14362 Emacs about it:
14363
14364 @lisp
14365 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
14366 @end lisp
14367
14368 Org-mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
14369 and to read captured notes from there.
14370
14371 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
14372 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
14373
14374 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
14375 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
14376 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
14377 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
14378 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
14379 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
14380 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
14381 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force ID properties
14382 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
14383 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
14384 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
14385 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
14386 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
14387 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
14388 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
14389 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
14390 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically
14391 in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
14392
14393 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14394 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
14395
14396 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
14397 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
14398 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
14399 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
14400 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
14401
14402 @enumerate
14403 @item
14404 Org moves all entries found in
14405 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
14406 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
14407 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
14408 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
14409 @item
14410 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
14411 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
14412 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
14413 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
14414 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
14415 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
14416 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
14417 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
14418 @item
14419 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
14420 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
14421 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
14422 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
14423 agenda line.
14424 @table @kbd
14425 @kindex ?
14426 @item ?
14427 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
14428 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
14429 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
14430 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
14431 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
14432 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
14433 this flagged entry is finished.
14434 @end table
14435 @end enumerate
14436
14437 @kindex C-c a ?
14438 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
14439 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
14440 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
14441 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
14442 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
14443 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
14444 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
14445
14446 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
14447 @appendix History and acknowledgments
14448 @cindex acknowledgments
14449 @cindex history
14450 @cindex thanks
14451
14452 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
14453 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
14454 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
14455 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
14456 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
14457 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
14458 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
14459 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
14460 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
14461 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
14462 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
14463 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
14464 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
14465 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
14466 functionality directly into a notes file.
14467
14468 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
14469 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
14470 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
14471 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
14472 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
14473 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
14474 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
14475 let me know.
14476
14477 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
14478
14479 @table @i
14480 @item Bastien Guerry
14481 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
14482 integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain
14483 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
14484 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
14485 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
14486 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
14487 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
14488 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
14489 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
14490 programming and reproducible research.
14491 @item John Wiegley
14492 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
14493 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
14494 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
14495 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
14496 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
14497 of his great @file{remember.el}.
14498 @item Sebastian Rose
14499 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
14500 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
14501 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
14502 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
14503 single-key navigation.
14504 @end table
14505
14506 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
14507 know what I am missing here!
14508
14509 @itemize @bullet
14510
14511 @item
14512 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
14513 @item
14514 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
14515 @item
14516 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
14517 Org-mode website.
14518 @item
14519 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
14520 @item
14521 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
14522 @item
14523 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
14524 @item
14525 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
14526 @item
14527 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
14528 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
14529 @item
14530 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
14531 specified time.
14532 @item
14533 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
14534 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
14535 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
14536 @item
14537 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
14538 @item
14539 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
14540 @item
14541 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
14542 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
14543 them.
14544 @item
14545 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
14546 @item
14547 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
14548 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
14549 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
14550 @item
14551 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
14552 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
14553 @item
14554 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
14555 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
14556 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
14557 @item
14558 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
14559 HTML agendas.
14560 @item
14561 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
14562 @item
14563 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
14564 @item
14565 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
14566 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
14567 @item
14568 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
14569 @item
14570 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
14571 @item
14572 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
14573 @item
14574 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
14575 testing.
14576 @item
14577 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
14578 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
14579 @item
14580 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
14581 @item
14582 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
14583 @item
14584 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
14585 @item
14586 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
14587 book.
14588 @item
14589 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
14590 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
14591 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
14592 @item
14593 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
14594 patches.
14595 @item
14596 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
14597 @item
14598 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
14599 folded entries, and column view for properties.
14600 @item
14601 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
14602 @item
14603 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
14604 @item
14605 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
14606 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
14607 @item
14608 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
14609 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
14610 @item
14611 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
14612 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
14613 small fixes and patches.
14614 @item
14615 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
14616 @item
14617 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
14618 @item
14619 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
14620 basis.
14621 @item
14622 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
14623 happy.
14624 @item
14625 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
14626 @item
14627 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
14628 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
14629 @item
14630 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
14631 @item
14632 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
14633 @item
14634 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
14635 file links, and TAGS.
14636 @item
14637 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
14638 version of the reference card.
14639 @item
14640 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
14641 into Japanese.
14642 @item
14643 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
14644 @item
14645 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
14646 links, among other things.
14647 @item
14648 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
14649 provided frequent feedback.
14650 @item
14651 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
14652 into bundles of 20 for undo.
14653 @item
14654 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
14655 @item
14656 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
14657 control.
14658 @item
14659 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
14660 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
14661 @item
14662 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
14663 @item
14664 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
14665 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
14666 @item
14667 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
14668 extensive patches.
14669 @item
14670 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
14671 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
14672 @item
14673 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
14674 other things.
14675 @item
14676 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
14677 @item
14678 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
14679 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
14680 @item
14681 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
14682 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
14683 @item
14684 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
14685 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
14686 @item
14687 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
14688 subtrees.
14689 @item
14690 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
14691 @item
14692 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
14693 tweaks and features.
14694 @item
14695 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
14696 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
14697 @item
14698 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
14699 LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
14700 @item
14701 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
14702 with links transformation to Org syntax.
14703 @item
14704 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
14705 chapter about publishing.
14706 @item
14707 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with LaTeX and BEAMER export and
14708 enabled source code highlighling in Gnus.
14709 @item
14710 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
14711 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
14712 concept index for HTML export.
14713 @item
14714 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
14715 in HTML output.
14716 @item
14717 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
14718 @item
14719 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
14720 keyword.
14721 @item
14722 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
14723 system.
14724 @item
14725 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
14726 linking to Gnus.
14727 @item
14728 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
14729 work on a tty.
14730 @item
14731 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
14732 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
14733 @end itemize
14734
14735
14736 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
14737 @unnumbered Concept index
14738
14739 @printindex cp
14740
14741 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
14742 @unnumbered Key index
14743
14744 @printindex ky
14745
14746 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
14747 @unnumbered Command and function index
14748
14749 @printindex fn
14750
14751 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
14752 @unnumbered Variable index
14753
14754 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
14755 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
14756 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
14757
14758 @printindex vr
14759
14760 @bye
14761
14762 @c Local variables:
14763 @c fill-column: 77
14764 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
14765 @c paragraph-start: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
14766 @c paragraph-separate: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
14767 @c End:
14768
14769
14770 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre